- Latest available (Revised)
- Point in Time (01/04/2009)
- Original (As enacted)
Version Superseded: 21/07/2009
Point in time view as at 01/04/2009.
Finance Act 2002 is up to date with all changes known to be in force on or before 30 November 2024. There are changes that may be brought into force at a future date. Changes that have been made appear in the content and are referenced with annotations.
Changes and effects yet to be applied by the editorial team are only applicable when viewing the latest version or prospective version of legislation. They are therefore not accessible when viewing legislation as at a specific point in time. To view the ‘Changes to Legislation’ information for this provision return to the latest version view using the options provided in the ‘What Version’ box above.
Section 4
1(1)Section 36 of the Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 (c. 4) (beer: charge of excise duty) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1), for “at the rate of £11.89 per hectolitre per cent of alcohol in the beer" substitute “ at the rates specified in subsection (1AA) below ”.
(3)After subsection (1), insert—
“(1AA)The rates at which the duty shall be charged are—
(a)in the case of beer that is not small brewery beer, £11.89 per hectolitre per cent of alcohol in the beer;
(b)in the case of small brewery beer produced in a singleton brewery, the rate per hectolitre per cent of alcohol in the beer that is given by section 36D below;
(c)in the case of small brewery beer produced in a co-operated brewery, the rate per hectolitre per cent of alcohol in the beer that is given by section 36F below.”.
2U.K.In that Act, after that section (and before the heading “Reliefs from excise duty") insert—
“Reduced rates of excise duty
(1)For the purposes of section 36(1AA) above (but subject to subsection (2) below)—
(a)whether beer produced in a singleton brewery is “small brewery beer” is determined in accordance with section 36C below, and
(b)whether beer produced in a co-operated brewery is “small brewery beer” is determined in accordance with section 36E below.
(2)Beer is not small brewery beer if it is produced by a person on any premises in circumstances in which he is required to be, but is not, registered under section 47 below in respect of those premises.
(1)The following provisions of this section have effect for the purposes of section 36(1AA) above, section 36A above, this section and sections 36C to 36F below.
(2)A brewery is a “singleton brewery” at any particular time in a calendar year if it is not a co-operated brewery at that time.
(3)A brewery is a “co-operated brewery” at any particular time in a calendar year if—
(a)a person who produces beer in the brewery at that time or any earlier time in that year, or
(b)a person connected with such a person,
also produces beer in any other brewery at that time or any earlier time in that year.
(4)“Brewery” means premises (whether or not in the United Kingdom) on which beer is produced and that are situated physically apart from any other premises on which beer is produced.
(5)“The standard beer duty rate” means the rate of duty specified by section 36(1AA)(a) above.
(6)References to “the grossed-up amount” of an estimate of the amount of a brewery’s production in a calendar year are to the amount given by—
where—
E is the amount of the estimate, and
N is the number of days (if any) in the calendar year before the brewery begins to be used as beer-production premises.
(7)References to a brewery being used as beer-production premises are, in the case of a brewery in the United Kingdom, to there being at least one person who is required to be registered under section 47 below in respect of the brewery.
(8)Any question whether a person is connected with another shall be determined in accordance with section 839 of the Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988.
(1)This section applies to beer produced in a brewery at a time in a calendar year (“the current year”) when the brewery is a singleton brewery.
(2)The beer is “small brewery beer” if the following conditions are satisfied; but this is subject to subsections (9) and (10) below.
(3)The first condition is that either—
(a)no beer was produced in the brewery in the previous calendar year (“the previous year”), or
(b)the amount of beer produced in the brewery in the previous year was not more than 30,000 hectolitres.
(4)For the purposes of subsection (3)(b) above, where the brewery was in use as beer-production premises during part only of the previous year, the amount of beer produced in the previous year in the brewery shall be taken to have been—
where—
A is the amount of beer actually produced in the previous year in the brewery, and
D is the number of days in that part of the previous year.
(5)The second condition is that the amount of the estimate under subsection (9) below of the brewery’s production in the current year is not more than 30,000 hectolitres.
(6)The third condition is that if the brewery begins to be used as beer-production premises part-way through the current year, the grossed-up amount of that estimate is not more than 30,000 hectolitres.
(7)The fourth condition is that less than half of the beer produced in the brewery in the previous year was produced under licence.
(8)The fifth condition is that the beer is not produced under licence.
(9)Beer produced in the brewery in the current year before the person who first produces beer in the brewery in that year has made a reasonable estimate of the amount of beer that will be produced in the brewery in that year is not small brewery beer.
(10)Beer produced in the brewery in the current year after the amount of beer produced in the brewery in the current year has reached 30,000 hectolitres is not small brewery beer.
(11)Subsection (10) above is without prejudice to section 167(4) of the Customs and Excise Management Act 1979 (recovery of duty unpaid by reason of untrue document or statement).
(1)This section applies to small brewery beer produced in a brewery at a time in a calendar year (“the current year”) when the brewery is a singleton brewery.
(2)The rate of duty in the case of that beer (“the brewery rate”) is determined in accordance with this section.
(3)Subsection (4) below applies if—
(a)beer was produced in the brewery in the previous calendar year (“the previous year”) and the amount produced in the brewery in that year was not more than 5,000 hectolitres, or
(b)no beer was produced in the brewery in the previous year and the grossed-up amount of the estimate under section 36C(9) above of the brewery’s production in the current year is not more than 5,000 hectolitres.
(4)If this subsection applies, “the brewery rate” is 50% of the standard beer duty rate at the time concerned; but this is subject to rounding under subsection (7) below.
(5)Subsection (6) below applies if—
(a)beer was produced in the brewery in the previous year and the amount produced in the brewery in that year was more than 5,000 hectolitres but not more than 30,000 hectolitres, or
(b)no beer was produced in the brewery in the previous year and the grossed-up amount of the estimate under section 36C(9) above of the brewery’s production in the current year is more than 5,000 hectolitres but not more than 30,000 hectolitres.
(6)If this subsection applies, “the brewery rate” is, subject to rounding under subsection (7) below, given by—
where—
if this subsection applies by reason of subsection (5)(a) above, P is the amount, in hectolitres, of beer produced in the brewery in the previous year, and
if this subsection applies by reason of subsection (5)(b) above, P is the grossed-up amount (expressed in hectolitres) mentioned in subsection (5)(b).
(7)Where a rate given by subsection (4) or (6) above would (apart from this subsection) not be a whole number of pennies, the rate given by that subsection shall be taken to be the rate actually given by that subsection rounded up to the nearest penny.
(8)Where the brewery was in use as beer-production premises during part only of the previous year, for the purposes of subsections (3)(a), (5)(a) and (6) above the amount of beer produced in the brewery in the previous year shall be taken to have been—
where—
A is the amount of beer actually produced in the previous year in the brewery, and
D is the number of days in that part of the previous year.
(1)This section applies to beer produced in a brewery at a time in a calendar year (“the current year”) when the brewery is a co-operated brewery.
(2)The beer is “small brewery beer” if the following conditions are satisfied; but this is subject to subsections (10) and (11) below.
(3)In this section—
“the group” means the group of breweries consisting of—
the co-operated brewery, and
every brewery (other than the co-operated brewery) in which beer is produced at the time mentioned in subsection (1) above, or at any earlier time in the current year, by—
a person who produces beer in the co-operated brewery at the time so mentioned or at any earlier time in the current year, or
a person connected with such a person;
“group brewery” means a brewery that is in the group;
“the previous year” means the calendar year immediately preceding the current year.
(4)The first condition is that either—
(a)no beer was produced in the previous year in the group, or
(b)the amount given by PY + GE is not more than 30,000 hectolitres, where—
PY is the amount of beer produced in the previous year in the group, and
GE is the aggregate of the grossed-up amount of each estimate that—
(i) is an estimate for the purposes of subsection (10) below of the amount of the production in the current year in a group brewery in which no beer was produced in the previous year, and
(ii) is made no later than the time mentioned in subsection (1) above.
(5)For the purposes of subsection (4)(b) above, where a group brewery was in use as beer-production premises during part only of the previous year, the amount of beer produced in the previous year in that brewery shall be taken to have been—
where—
A is the amount of beer actually produced in the previous year in that brewery, and
D is the number of days in that part of the previous year.
(6)The second condition is that the aggregate of each estimate that—
(a)is an estimate for the purposes of subsection (10) below of the amount of a group brewery’s production in the current year, and
(b)is made no later than the time mentioned in subsection (1) above,
is not more than 30,000 hectolitres.
(7)The third condition is that if any group brewery begins to be used as beer-production premises part-way through the current year, the aggregate of the grossed-up amount of each estimate that—
(a)is an estimate for the purposes of subsection (10) below of the amount of a group brewery’s production in the current year, and
(b)is made no later than the time mentioned in subsection (1) above,
is not more than 30,000 hectolitres.
(8)The fourth condition is that less than half of the beer produced in the previous year in each group brewery was produced under licence.
(9)The fifth condition is that the beer is not produced under licence.
(10)Beer produced in the co-operated brewery at an unestimated time is not small brewery beer; and here “unestimated time” means a time in the current year when there is a group brewery for which there does not exist a reasonable estimate, made by the person who first produces beer in that brewery in that year, of the amount of beer that will be produced in that brewery in that year.
(11)Beer produced in the co-operated brewery in the current year after the amount of beer produced in the group in the current year has reached 30,000 hectolitres is not small brewery beer.
(12)Subsection (11) above is without prejudice to section 167(4) of the Customs and Excise Management Act 1979 (recovery of duty unpaid by reason of untrue document or statement).
(1)This section applies to small brewery beer produced in a brewery at a time in a calendar year (“the current year”) when the brewery is a co-operated brewery.
(2)The rate of duty in the case of that beer (“the brewery rate”) is determined in accordance with this section.
(3)In this section—
“the group” means the group of breweries consisting of—
the co-operated brewery, and
every brewery (other than the co-operated brewery) in which beer is produced at the time mentioned in subsection (1) above, or at any earlier time in the current year, by—
a person who produces beer in the co-operated brewery at the time so mentioned or at any earlier time in the current year, or
a person connected with such a person;
“group brewery” means a brewery that is in the group;
“the previous year” means the calendar year immediately preceding the current year;
“the notional previous year’s production” has the meaning given by subsection (4) below.
(4)In this section “the notional previous year’s production” means the amount, in hectolitres, given by PY + GE where—
PY is the amount of beer produced in the group in the previous year, and
GE is the aggregate of the grossed-up amount of each estimate that—
(a) is an estimate for the purposes of section 36E(10) above of the amount of the production in the current year in a group brewery in which no beer was produced in the previous year, and
(b) is made no later than the time mentioned in subsection (1) above.
(5)Where a group brewery was in use as beer-production premises during part only of the previous year, in calculating PY for the purposes of subsection (4) above the amount of beer produced in that brewery in the previous year shall be taken to have been—
where—
A is the amount of beer actually produced in the previous year in that brewery, and
D is the number of days in that part of the previous year.
(6)Subsection (7) below applies if—
(a)beer was produced in at least one group brewery in the previous year and the notional previous year’s production is not more than 5,000 hectolitres, or
(b)no beer was produced in the group in the previous year and the aggregate of each estimate that—
(i)is an estimate for the purposes of section 36E(10) above of the amount of a group brewery’s production in the current year, and
(ii)is made no later than the time mentioned in subsection (1) above,
is not more than 5,000 hectolitres.
(7)If this subsection applies, “the brewery rate” is 50% of the standard rate at the time mentioned in subsection (1) above; but this is subject to rounding under subsection (10) below.
(8)Subsection (9) below applies if—
(a)beer was produced in at least one group brewery in the previous year and the notional previous year’s production is more than 5,000 hectolitres but not more than 30,000 hectolitres, or
(b)no beer was produced in the group in the previous year and the aggregate mentioned in subsection (6)(b) above is more than 5,000 hectolitres but not more than 30,000 hectolitres.
(9)If this subsection applies, “the brewery rate” is, subject to rounding under subsection (10) below, given by—
where—
if this subsection applies by reason of subsection (8)(a) above, P is the previous year’s notional production,
if this subsection applies by reason of subsection (8)(b) above, P is the amount, in hectolitres, of the aggregate mentioned in subsection (6)(b) above, and
“the standard rate” means the standard beer duty rate at the time mentioned in subsection (1) above.
(10)Where a rate given by subsection (7) or (9) above would (apart from this subsection) not be a whole number of pennies, the rate given by that subsection shall be taken to be the rate actually given by that subsection rounded up to the nearest penny.
(1)Subsection (3) below applies if—
(a)duty is charged by section 36 above on any beer, and
(b)it appears at the excise duty point that the beer is small brewery beer for the purposes of section 36(1AA) above, but
(c)it turns out that the beer was not small brewery beer for those purposes (because, for example, circumstances were not as they appeared at that point or they subsequently changed).
(2)Subsection (3) below also applies if—
(a)duty is charged by section 36 above on any beer that is small brewery beer for the purposes of section 36(1AA) above, and
(b)the rate of duty that at the excise duty point appeared to be the correct rate turns out to have been lower than the correct rate (because, for example, circumstances were not as they appeared at that point or they subsequently changed).
(3)In any such case the Commissioners—
(a)may assess the amount that is the difference between—
(i)the actual amount of the duty charged on the beer by section 36 above, and
(ii)the lower amount that, at the excise duty point, appeared to be the amount charged,
as being excise duty due from the person liable to pay the duty charged on the beer by section 36 above, and
(b)may notify him or his representative accordingly.
(4)Where two or more persons are liable to pay the duty charged on the beer—
(a)the reference in subsection (3)(a) above to the person liable to pay the duty is to any one or more of those persons, and
(b)the reference in subsection (3)(b) above to notifying the person liable or his representative is to notifying each person assessed or his representative.
(1)The Treasury may by order made by statutory instrument make provision amending this Act for the purpose of causing excise duty to be charged on a description of beer—
(a)at a reduced rate instead of at the standard rate;
(b)at the standard rate instead of at a reduced rate;
(c)at a different reduced rate.
(2)In this section—
“reduced rate” means a rate lower than the standard rate, and
“the standard rate” means the rate specified by section 36(1AA)(a) above.
(3)An order under subsection (1) above may—
(a)make different provision for different cases;
(b)make such consequential amendments in this Act and other enactments as appear to the Treasury to be necessary or expedient;
(c)make such other consequential provision, and such incidental and transitional provision, as appears to the Treasury to be necessary or expedient.
(4)A statutory instrument by which there is made an order under subsection (1) above shall be laid before the House of Commons after being made.
Unless the instrument is approved by the House of Commons before the expiration of 28 days beginning with the date on which the instrument was made, the order shall cease to have effect on the expiration of that period.
Where the order so ceases to have effect, that does not prejudice—
(a)anything previously done under the order, or
(b)the making of a new order.
In reckoning any such period of 28 days, no account shall be taken of any time during which Parliament is dissolved or prorogued or during which the House of Commons is adjourned for more than 4 days.”.
Commencement Information
I1Sch. 1 para. 2 wholly in force; Sch. 1 para. 2 in force for specified purposes at 1.6.2002, otherwise Sch. 1 para. 2 in force at 24.7.2002, see. s. 4
3U.K.In section 49(1) of the Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 (c. 4) (beer regulations), after paragraph (j) insert—
“(k)requiring the production of certificates as to matters relating to beer imported into the United Kingdom and the beer’s production and producer, whether as alternative conditions for charging the duty on the beer at a rate lower than that specified by section 36(1AA)(a) above or as evidence that conditions for charging the duty at such a rate are satisfied.”.
4(1)The Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In section 12A(3)(bb) (recovery of amounts assessed under the Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979), for “or 11" substitute “ , 11 or 36G ”.
(3)In section 12B(2) (meaning of “relevant time" in section 12A), after paragraph (eb) insert—
“(ec)in the case of an assessment under section 36G of that Act, the the time at which the requirement to pay the duty took effect (which time, in a case where there was an excise duty point for the beer fixed under section 1 of the Finance (No. 2) Act 1992, is that excise duty point);”.
(4)In section 14(1)(ba) (review of assessments), for “or 11" substitute “ , 11 or 36G ”.
Section 5
1The Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 (c. 5) is amended as follows.
2In section 6A(1) (fuel substitutes: charge of duty) after “which is not hydrocarbon oil" insert “ , biodiesel or bioblend ”.
3In section 11 (rebate on heavy oil), after subsection (5) insert—
“(6)No rebate shall be allowed under this section in respect of bioblend.”.
F14. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F1Sch. 2 para. 4 omitted (retrospective to 1.4.2008) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 5 paras. 25(d)(ii), 26(b)
5(1)In section 20AAA (mixing of rebated oil), after subsection (2A) insert—
“(2B)Where a mixture is produced in contravention of Part 2B of Schedule 2A to this Act, a duty of excise shall be charged on the mixture.”.
(2)In section 20AAA(3) (producer of mixture liable to pay duty), for “or (2A)" substitute “ , (2A) or (2B) ”.
(3)After Part 2A of Schedule 2A (mixing of rebated oil) insert—
7B(1)A mixture is produced in contravention of this paragraph if it is produced by mixing—
(a)biodiesel or a substance containing biodiesel, and
(b)rebated heavy oil.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1)(b) above “rebated heavy oil” means heavy oil in respect of which a rebate has been allowed under section 11 of this Act.”.
(4)In paragraph 9(1A) of that Schedule (rates of duty for mixtures of heavy oil), after “subsection (2A)" insert “ or (2B) ”.
(5)In paragraph 10(1) of that Schedule (credit for duty paid on ingredients of mixture), after “section 6" insert “ , 6AA, 6AB or 6A ”.
(6)In section 20AAB (mixing of rebated oil: supplementary), in subsection (1)(a) for “or (2A)" substitute “ , (2A) or (2B) ”.
(7)In section 22 (prohibition on use of petrol substitutes on which duty has not been paid), after subsection (1) insert—
“(1AA)Where any person—
(a)puts any biodiesel to a chargeable use (within the meaning of section 6AA above), and
(b)knows or has reasonable cause to believe that there is duty charged under section 6AA above on that biodiesel which has not been paid and is not lawfully deferred,
his putting the biodiesel to that use shall attract a penalty under section 9 of the Finance Act 1994 (civil penalties), and any goods in respect of which any person contravenes this subsection shall be liable to forfeiture.”.
(8)In section 22(1A) (section 10 of the Finance Act 1994 does not apply), after “subsection (1)" insert “ or (1AA) ”.
6In section 27(1) (interpretation) at the appropriate places insert—
““bioblend” has the meaning given by section 6AB(2) above;”,
and
““biodiesel” has the meaning given by section 2AA above;”.
Prospective
7(1)In section 6AB (which charges excise duty on bioblend and is inserted by section 5 of this Act), in subsection (1), omit the words from “and delivered" to the end.
(2)For subsection (6) of that section substitute—
“(6)Where—
(a)imported bioblend is removed to relevant premises,
(b)the bioblend undergoes a production process at those premises or any other relevant premises, and
(c)any duty charged on the importation of the bioblend has not become payable at any time before the production time,
the duty charged on importation shall not become payable at any time after the production time.
(7)In subsection (6) above—
“the production time” means the time at which the bioblend undergoes the production process; and
“relevant premises” means—
a refinery,
other premises used for the production of hydrocarbon oil, or
premises of such description as may be specified in regulations made by the Commissioners.
(8)For the purposes of subsection (6) above, bioblend undergoes a production process if—
(a)hydrocarbon oil, or bioblend, of any description, or biodiesel, is obtained from it, or
(b)it is subjected to any process of purification or blending.”.
Section 6
1U.K.In the Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 (c. 5), after section 23 insert—
(1)If a revenue trader who is not a registered excise dealer and shipper—
(a)buys or sells controlled oil in the course of a trade or business, or
(b)in the course of a trade or business deals in controlled oil,
his buying or selling, or dealing in, the oil shall attract a penalty under section 9 of the Finance Act 1994 (civil penalties).
(2)Subsection (1) above does not apply to the buying of oil by a revenue trader if—
(a)the oil is for use by the trader, and
(b)that use does not involve selling or dealing in hydrocarbon oil.
(3)Subsection (1) above does not apply to the selling of oil by a revenue trader if—
(a)that oil was for use by the trader,
(b)that use did not involve selling or dealing in hydrocarbon oil,
(c)that use came to an end before the oil was used, and
(d)the oil is sold after the use ends.
(4)Where a revenue trader who is not a registered excise dealer and shipper is entitled to the possession of any controlled oil, the oil is liable to forfeiture.
(5)Subsection (4) above does not apply to oil if—
(a)that oil is for use by the revenue trader, and
(b)that use does not involve selling or dealing in hydrocarbon oil.
(6)Subsection (4) above does not apply to oil if—
(a)the oil was for use by the revenue trader,
(b)that use did not involve selling or dealing in hydrocarbon oil,
(c)that use has come to an end,
(d)that use came to an end before the oil was used, and
(e)the oil is being held pending sale or other disposal.
(7)Where oil is liable to forfeiture by virtue of subsection (4) above—
(a)anything mixed with the oil,
(b)any container in which the oil (and anything mixed with it) is kept, and
(c)any equipment kept for dispensing the contents of any such container,
is liable to forfeiture.
(1)The Commissioners may by regulations make provision for—
(a)exceptions to section 23A(1) above in addition to those allowed by section 23A(2) and (3) above;
(b)exceptions to section 23A(4) above in addition to those allowed by section 23A(5) and (6) above;
(c)exceptions to section 23A(7) above.
(2)Regulations under subsection (1) above may provide for exceptions allowed by such regulations to have effect subject to conditions—
(a)specified by such regulations;
(b)specified by the Commissioners under such regulations.”.
Commencement Information
I2Sch. 3 para. 1 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes , see s. 6(3)(4); Sch. 3 para. 1 in force at 1.4.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2002/3056, art. 2
2U.K.In section 100H(1) of the Customs and Excise Management Act 1979 (c. 2) (particular provision that may be made by registered excise dealers and shippers regulations), after paragraph (n) insert—
“(p)authorised by section 24AA of the Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 (regulation of traders in controlled oil).”.
3U.K.In the Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 (c. 5), after section 24 insert—
(1)For the purposes of section 100H(1)(p) of the Management Act (registered excise dealers and shippers regulations may, in particular, make provision authorised by this section), this section authorises provision—
(a)requiring traders in controlled oil to notify prescribed information;
(b)requiring traders in controlled oil to make prescribed returns;
(c)authorising a trader in controlled oil to carry out or arrange for the carrying out of any prescribed activity falling within section 100H(1)(b) of the Management Act in relation to controlled oil, but subject to prescribed conditions or restrictions;
(d)requiring a trader in controlled oil to give security by prescribed means for amounts that may become due from him by way of repayment of rebate;
(e)for taking into account, in determining whether a trader in controlled oil has—
(i)contravened any provision of registered excise dealers and shippers regulations, or
(ii)failed to comply with any prescribed condition, restriction or requirement,
the extent to which the trader has followed guidance issued by the Commissioners (including guidance issued after the making of provision under this paragraph referring to it).
(2)In this section—
“prescribed” has the meaning given by section 100H(3) of the Management Act;
“trader in controlled oil” means a registered excise dealer and shipper carrying on a trade or business that consists of or includes the dealing in, buying or selling of controlled oil.”.
4(1)Section 27 of the Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 (c. 5) (interpretation) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (1) insert (at the appropriate place)—
““controlled oil” means hydrocarbon oil in respect of which a rebate has been allowed under section 11(1)(b), (ba) or (c) or 13AA;”.
(3)In the Table set out in subsection (3) (expressions used in the Act that have a meaning given by another Act included in the Customs and Excise Acts 1979), under the heading “Management Act" insert (at the appropriate places)—
““registered excise dealer and shipper"”,
and
““revenue trader"”.
5U.K.The Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 is amended as follows.
6U.K.In section 12(1) (no rebate allowed on heavy oil intended for use in a road vehicle), after “no rebate" insert “ under section 11 above ”.
7U.K.In section 12(2) (oil not to be used in road vehicles if rebate has been allowed under section 11(1) or 13AA(1)), for “section 11(1)" substitute “ section 11 ”.
8U.K.In section 24(2) (regulations made for the purposes of section 12 or 13AA), for “under subsection (2) of that section" substitute “ under subsection (2) of section 12, or subsection (3) of section 13AA, ”.
9U.K.In section 27(1) (interpretation), in the definition of “rebate", after “section 11," insert “ 13AA, ”.
Section 12
1U.K.The Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 (c. 63) is amended as follows.
2U.K.For sections 6 to 8 (pool betting duty: charge, rate and payment) substitute—
“Pool betting duty
A duty of excise to be known as pool betting duty shall be charged in accordance with sections 7 to 8C.
(1)If the amount of a person’s net pool betting receipts for an accounting period is greater than zero, pool betting duty is charged on those receipts.
(2)The amount of that duty is 15 per cent of the amount of the receipts.
For the purposes of section 7, the amount of a person’s net pool betting receipts for an accounting period is—
where—
S is the aggregate of amounts falling due to the person in the accounting period in respect of dutiable pool bets,
E is the aggregate of expenses and profits falling within section 7E(2) that are attributable to the accounting period, and
W is the aggregate of amounts paid by the person in the accounting period by way of winnings on dutiable pool bets (irrespective of when the bets were made or determined).
(1)For the purposes of a calculation under section 7A of the amount of a person’s net pool betting receipts for any accounting period, a bet (wherever made) is a “dutiable pool bet” if—
(a)the bet is made by way of pool betting, and
(b)the following conditions are satisfied.
(2)The first condition is that—
(a)the bet is made by means of a totalisator situated in the United Kingdom and that person is the operator, or
(b)the bet is made otherwise than by means of a totalisator and that person is the promoter and is in the United Kingdom.
(3)The second condition is that the bet is not—
(a)made by way of sponsored pool betting,
(b)made as mentioned in section 4(3), or
(c)made for community benefit.
(4)The third condition is that if the bet was made before 31st March 2002, at least one event to which it relates takes place on or after that date.
(1)This section applies for the purpose of calculating S in a calculation under section 7A.
(2)Any payment that entitles a person to make a bet shall, if he makes the bet, be treated as stake money on the bet.
(3)All payments made—
(a)for or on account of or in connection with bets that are dutiable pool bets for the purposes of the calculation,
(b)in addition to the stake money, and
(c)by the persons making the bets,
shall be treated as amounts due in respect of the bets except in so far as the contrary is proved by the person whose net pool betting receipts are being calculated.
(1)Subsections (2) to (5) apply for the purpose of calculating S in a calculation under section 7A but have effect subject to any regulations under subsection (6).
(2)Where—
(a)a person makes a bet, and
(b)the bet relates to a single event, or to two or more events all taking place on the same day,
any sum due to a person in respect of the bet shall be treated as falling due on the day on which the event or events take place.
(3)Where—
(a)a person makes a bet, and
(b)subsection (2) does not apply,
any sum due to a person in respect of the bet shall (subject to subsection (5)) be treated as falling due when the bet is made.
(4)Subsections (2) and (3) have effect in relation to a sum irrespective of when it is actually paid or required to be paid (even where a sum that those subsections require to be treated as falling due on or after 31st March 2002 was actually paid, or required to be paid, before that date).
(5)As respects a bet made before 31st March 2002 that relates to events at least one of which takes place before that date and at least one of which takes place on or after that date, any sum paid on or after that date in respect of the bet shall be treated as falling due when it is paid.
(6)The Commissioners may by regulations make provision as to when any sum due to a person in respect of a bet is to be treated as falling due for the purpose of calculating S in a calculation under section 7A.
(7)Provision made by regulations under subsection (6) may not provide for a sum due to a person in respect of a bet to be treated as falling due—
(a)earlier than when the bet is made, or
(b)later than when the bet is determined.
(8)Regulations made under subsection (6) may—
(a)make provision that applies generally or only in relation to a specified description of bet;
(b)make different provision for different purposes;
(c)make provision relating to bets made before the regulations are made (including bets made before the passing of the Finance Act 2002);
(d)make transitional provision.
(1)Subsections (2) and (3) apply for the purpose of calculating E in a calculation under section 7A.
(2)The expenses and profits falling within this subsection are (subject to subsection (3))—
(a)those of the person whose net pool betting receipts are being calculated, and
(b)those of any other person concerned with or benefiting from the promotion of the betting concerned.
(3)Expenses and profits do not fall within subsection (2) so far as they are—
(a)provided out of amounts due, in respect of bets that are dutiable pool bets for the purposes of the calculation, to the person whose net pool betting receipts are being calculated, or
(b)referable to matters other than—
(i)the promotion or management of the betting concerned, or
(ii)activities ancillary to, or connected with, such promotion or management.
(4)The Commissioners may by regulations make provision as to the accounting period to which expenses and profits falling within subsection (2) are to be treated as attributable for the purpose of calculating E in a calculation under section 7A.
(5)Regulations made under subsection (4) may—
(a)make provision that applies generally or only in relation to a specified description of bet;
(b)make different provision for different purposes;
(c)make provision applying in respect of expenses incurred, and profits accruing, before the regulations are made (including any incurred or accruing before the passing of the Finance Act 2002);
(d)make transitional provision.
(1)Subsections (2) to (5) apply for the purpose of calculating W in a calculation under section 7A.
(2)The reference to paying an amount to a person includes a reference to holding it in an account if the person is notified that the amount is being held for him in the account and that he is entitled to withdraw it on demand.
(3)The return of a stake shall be treated as a payment by way of winnings.
(4)Only payments of money shall be taken into account.
(5)Where a bet made before 31st March 2002 relates to events at least one of which takes place before that date and at least one of which takes place on or after that date, no account shall be taken of any payment by way of winnings on the bet.
(6)The Commissioners may by regulations make provision as to when amounts paid by way of winnings are to be treated as being paid for the purposes of calculating W in a calculation under section 7A.
(7)Regulations made under subsection (6) may—
(a)make provision that applies generally or only in relation to a specified description of bet;
(b)make different provision for different purposes;
(c)make provision applying in respect of amounts paid before the regulations are made (including amounts paid before the passing of the Finance Act 2002);
(d)make transitional provision.
(1)Pool betting duty charged on a person’s net pool betting receipts for an accounting period—
(a)becomes due at the end of the period,
(b)shall be paid by the person, and
(c)shall, subject to any regulations under subsection (3) and any directions under paragraph 3 of Schedule 1 to this Act, be paid when it becomes due.
(2)Pool betting duty that is due to be paid may be recovered from the following persons as if they were jointly and severally liable to pay the duty—
(a)the person on whose net pool betting receipts the duty is charged (“the primary payer”);
(b)a person responsible for the management of any business in the course of which any bets have been made that are dutiable pool bets for the purposes of calculations under section 7A of the amount of the primary payer’s net pool betting receipts for any accounting period;
(c)a person responsible for the management of any totalisator used for the purposes of any such business;
(d)where a person within any of paragraphs (a) to (c) is a company, a director.
(3)The Commissioners may by regulations—
(a)make provision as to when pool betting duty is to be paid (including provision repealing paragraph 3 of Schedule 1 to this Act and the reference to that paragraph in subsection (1)(c));
(b)make provision as to how pool betting duty is to be paid.
(4)Regulations made under subsection (3) may—
(a)make provision that applies generally or only in relation to a specified person or class of person;
(b)make different provision for different purposes;
(c)make transitional provision.
(1)For the purposes of sections 6 to 8 (but subject to any direction under subsection (3)), a bet is made “for community benefit” if—
(a)the promoter of the betting concerned is a community society or is bound to pay all benefits accruing from the betting to such a society, and
(b)the person making the bet knows, when making it, that the purpose of the betting is to benefit such a society.
(2)In the case of a bet made by means of a totalisator, the reference in subsection (1) to the promoter of the betting concerned is a reference to the operator.
(3)The Commissioners may direct that any bet specified by the direction, or of a description so specified, is not a bet made for community benefit.
(4)The power conferred by subsection (3) may not be exercised unless the Commissioners consider that an unreasonably large part of the amounts paid in respect of the bets concerned will, or may, be applied otherwise than—
(a)in the payment of winnings, or
(b)for the benefit of a community society.
(5)In this section “community society” means—
(a)a society established and conducted for charitable purposes only, or
(b)a society established and conducted wholly or mainly for the support of athletic sports or athletic games and not established or conducted for purposes of private gain.
(6)In this section “society” includes any club, institution, organisation or association of persons, by whatever name called.
(1)For the purposes of sections 6 to 8—
(a)each period that ends with the last Saturday in a calendar month, and begins with the Sunday immediately following the previous such Saturday, is an accounting period, but
(b)the Commissioners may by regulations make provision for some other specified period to be an accounting period.
(2)Regulations made under subsection (1)(b) may—
(a)make provision that applies generally or only in relation to a specified person or class of person;
(b)make different provision for different purposes;
(c)make transitional provision.
(1)For the purposes of sections 6 to 8A, “bet” does not include the taking of a ticket or chance in a lottery.
(2)Where payments are made for the chance of winning any money or money’s worth on terms under which the persons making the payments have a power of selection that may (directly or indirectly) determine the winner, those payments shall be treated as bets for the purposes of sections 6 to 8A notwithstanding that the power is not exercised.
(3)Subsection (2) has effect subject to section 12(3).
(4)Where any payment entitles a person to take part in a transaction that is, on his part only, not a bet made by way of pool betting by reason of his not in fact making any stake as if the transaction were such a bet, the transaction shall be treated as such a bet for the purposes of pool betting duty (and section 7C(3) shall apply to any such payment).”.
Commencement Information
I3Sch. 4 para. 2 wholly in force; Sch. 4 para. 2 in force at 31.3.2002 for specified purposes, otherwise in force at 24.7.2002, see. s. 12(5)(7)(a)(8)
3U.K.In section 2(2) (bets to which section 2(1) does not apply)—
(a)in paragraph (b), after “bet," insert “ or ”, and
(b)omit paragraph (d) and the word “or" preceding it.
4U.K.In section 4(6) (bets to which subsections (1) to (3) do not apply), for the words from “do not apply" to the end substitute “ do not apply to on-course bets. ”.
5U.K.In section 9(2) (bets to which section applies), omit “or coupon betting" (in both places).
6U.K.In section 9(3) (bets to which section does not apply)—
(a)in paragraph (a), omit “or coupon betting",
(b)for sub-paragraphs (i) to (iv) of paragraph (a) substitute—
“(i)the bet is not made by means of a totalisator, and
(ii)the promoter is in the Isle of Man; or”,
and
(c)in paragraph (aa)(i), omit “or coupon betting".
Commencement Information
I4Sch. 4 para. 6 wholly in force; Sch. 4 para. 6(b) in force at 31.3.2002; Sch. 4 para. 6(a)(c) in force at 24.4.2002, see s. 12(5)(6)
7U.K.For section 9(6) substitute—
“(6)Section 8C(1) to (3) above shall have effect for the purposes of subsections (2)(a) and (5) above as it has effect for the purposes of sections 6 to 8A above.”.
8U.K.Omit section 11 (definition of coupon betting).
9U.K.In section 12(3) (interpretation of sections 1 to 10 etc), omit “(except in sections 6, 7, 8, 9(2)(a) and 9(5) in their application to coupon betting)".
10(1)Schedule 1 (administration etc of betting duties) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In paragraph 1, in the definition of “pool betting business", at the end insert “ or would or might involve such sums becoming so payable if receipts from bets made for community benefit (as defined by section 8A of this Act) were not excluded from that duty. ”.
(3)After paragraph 2 insert—
“2A(1)Pool betting duty shall be under the care and management of the Commissioners.
(2)Without prejudice to any other provision of this Schedule, the Commissioners may make regulations providing for any matter for which provision appears to them to be necessary for the administration or enforcement of pool betting duty or for the protection of the revenue from pool betting duty.
(3)Regulations under sub-paragraph (2) above may in particular—
(a)provide for payments on account of pool betting duty which may become chargeable to be made in advance;
(b)provide for the giving of security by means of a deposit or otherwise for duty due or to become due.”.
(4)In paragraph 3, omit “shall be under the care and management of the Commissioners, and".
(5)In paragraph 4(2), for “sub-paragraphs (3) and (4)" substitute “ sub-paragraph (3) ”.
(6)Omit paragraph 4(4) to (6).
(7)In paragraph 5(1), for “made entry or given notice in accordance with paragraph 4(2) or (4)" substitute “ made entry in accordance with paragraph 4(2) ”.
(8)Renumber paragraph (b) of paragraph 5(2) as paragraph 5(3).
(9)In what remains of paragraph 5(2) after that renumbering, for the words from “paragraph 12(3) below, except that" to the end substitute “ sub-paragraph (3) below. ”.
(10)In paragraph 6(2), omit paragraph (b).
(11)Omit paragraphs 8 and 12.
(12)In paragraph 13(1)(b), after “any of paragraphs 2," insert “ 2A, ”.
(13)In paragraph 14(1), omit the words after paragraph (b).
F2(14). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F2Sch. 4 para. 10(14) repealed (19.7.2007) by Finance Act 2007 (c. 11), Sch. 27 Pt. 6(3)
Commencement Information
I5Sch. 6 para. 10 wholly in force; Sch. 6 para. 10(1)(2)(5)-(11)(13)(14) in force at 24.4.2002; Sch. 6 para. 10(3)(4)(12) in force at 24.7.2002, see s. 12(6)(7)(b)
11In section 1(3) of the Excise Duties (Surcharges or Rebates) Act 1979 (c. 8) (liability to duty other than pool betting duty adjusted if order under section in force when duty becomes due), omit the words from “, except that if the duty is pool betting duty" to the end.
12(1)Paragraph 6 of Schedule 5 to the Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) (decisions under the Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 that are subject to review and appeal) is amended as follows.
(2)In sub-paragraph (2)(a) (decisions in connection with requiring security for duty)—
(a)after “regulations under paragraph 2" insert “ or 2A ”, and
(b)after “in relation to general betting duty" insert “ or pool betting duty ”.
(3)After sub-paragraph (2) insert—
“(3)Any decision consisting in the giving of a direction under section 8A(3) of the Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 (pool betting duty: direction that bet is not made for community benefit).”.
Commencement Information
I6Sch. 4 para. 12 wholly in force; Sch. 4 para. 12(1)(3) in force at 24.4.2002; Sch. 4 para. 12(2) in force at 24.7.2002, see. s. 12(6)(7)(b)
13(1)If—
(a)stake money is paid before 31st March 2002 in respect of a bet to which this paragraph applies, and
(b)pool betting duty charged on that money before that date is not paid before 24th April 2002,
that duty ceases on 24th April 2002 to be charged on that money.
(2)If—
(a)stake money is paid before 31st March 2002 in respect of such a bet, and
(b)pool betting duty charged on that money before that date is paid before 24th April 2002,
the person who paid that duty becomes entitled on 24th April 2002 to a credit equal to the amount of the duty.
(3)Effect is given to such a credit by setting it (until fully utilised) against pool betting duty that the person is liable to pay in respect of accounting periods for the purposes of pool betting duty that begin on or after 31st March 2002 (taking earlier such periods before later ones).
(4)Such a credit does not—
(a)carry interest,
(b)affect the payability of the duty mentioned in sub-paragraph (2), or
(c)entitle any person to any payment in respect of the credit.
(5)This paragraph applies to a bet if—
(a)it is a dutiable pool bet for the purposes of a calculation, under the section 7A of the Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 inserted by this Schedule, of the amount of a person’s net pool betting receipts for any accounting period, and
(b)it is made before 31st March 2002 but all the events to which it relates take place on or after that date.
14Any notification under paragraph 4(4) of Schedule 1 to the Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 (c. 63) (duty to notify premises used for purposes of pool betting business in connection only with coupon betting) that is effective immediately before 24th April 2002 shall on and after that date have effect (until withdrawn) as a notification made on 31st March 2002 under paragraph 4(3) of that Schedule (duty to notify premises used for purposes of betting business in connection only with general betting).
Section 19
1U.K.The Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 (c. 22) is amended as follows.
Commencement Information
I7Sch. 5 para. 1 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 1 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
2U.K.For section 1(1) substitute—
“(1)A duty of excise (“vehicle excise duty”) shall be charged in respect of every mechanically propelled vehicle that—
(a)is registered under this Act (see section 21), or
(b)is not so registered but is used, or kept, on a public road in the United Kingdom.
(1A)Vehicle excise duty shall also be charged in respect of every thing (whether or not it is a vehicle) that has been, but has ceased to be, a mechanically propelled vehicle and—
(a)is registered under this Act, or
(b)is not so registered but is used, or kept, on a public road in the United Kingdom.
(1B)In the following provisions of this Act “vehicle” means—
(a)a mechanically propelled vehicle, or
(b)any thing (whether or not it is a vehicle) that has been, but has ceased to be, a mechanically propelled vehicle.
(1C)Vehicle excise duty charged in respect of a vehicle by subsection (1)(a) or (1A)(a) shall be paid on a licence to be taken out—
(a)by the person in whose name the vehicle is registered under this Act, or
(b)if that person is not the person keeping the vehicle, by either of those persons.
(1D)Vehicle excise duty charged in respect of a vehicle by subsection (1)(b) or (1A)(b) shall be paid on a licence to be taken out by the person keeping the vehicle.”.
Commencement Information
I8Sch. 5 para. 2 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 2 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
3U.K.For section 2(2) to (4) (rates where duty charged in respect of keeping but not use) substitute—
“(2)Subsection (1) applies subject to the following provisions of this section.
(3)Where vehicle excise duty is charged by section 1(1)(b) or (1A)(b) in respect of the keeping of a vehicle on a road (and not in respect of its use), duty in respect of such keeping is chargeable by reference to the general rate currently specified in paragraph 1(2) of Schedule 1.
(4)Subsections (5) and (6) apply where—
(a)vehicle excise duty is charged by section 1(1)(a) or (1A)(a) in respect of a vehicle, and
(b)were the vehicle not registered under this Act, duty would not be charged by section 1(1)(b) or (1A)(b) in respect of the use of the vehicle on a road.
(5)Where one or more use licences have previously been issued for the vehicle, the duty charged by section 1(1)(a) or (1A)(a) is chargeable by reference to the annual rate currently applicable to a vehicle of the same description as that of the vehicle on the occasion of the issue of that licence (or the last of those licences).
(6)In any other case, the duty charged by section 1(1)(a) or (1A)(a) is chargeable by reference to the general rate currently specified in paragraph 1(2) of Schedule 1.
(7)In subsection (5) “use licence” means—
(a)a vehicle licence issued for the use of a vehicle, or
(b)a vehicle licence that is issued by reason of a vehicle being registered under this Act but which would have been issued for the use of the vehicle if the vehicle had not been registered under this Act.”.
Commencement Information
I9Sch. 5 para. 3 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 3 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
4U.K.For section 7(4) (vehicle licence valid only for vehicle for which it is issued) substitute—
“(4)A vehicle licence is issued for the vehicle specified in the application for the licence (and for no other).”.
Commencement Information
I10Sch. 5 para. 4 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 4 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
5U.K.After section 7 insert—
(1)Regulations may make provision for a supplement of a prescribed amount to be payable in prescribed cases where—
(a)a vehicle licence taken out for a vehicle expires, and
(b)no vehicle licence is issued for the vehicle—
(i)before the end of such period beginning with the expiry of the expired licence as may be prescribed, and
(ii)for a period beginning with that expiry.
(2)A supplement under this section—
(a)shall be payable by such person, or jointly and severally by such persons, as may be prescribed;
(b)shall become payable at such time as may be prescribed;
(c)may be of an amount that varies according to the length of the period between—
(i)the expiry of the licence by reason of whose non-renewal the supplement becomes payable, and
(ii)the time at which the supplement is paid or that licence is renewed.
(3)A supplement under this section that has become payable—
(a)is in addition to any vehicle excise duty charged in respect of the vehicle concerned;
(b)does not cease to be payable by reason of a vehicle licence being taken out for the vehicle after the supplement has become payable;
(c)may, without prejudice to section 6 or 7B(2) and (3) or any other provision of this Act, be recovered as a debt due to the Crown.
(4)In this section—
(a)references to the expiry of a vehicle licence include a reference to—
(i)its surrender, and
(ii)its being treated as no longer in force for the purposes of subsection (2) of section 31A by subsection (4) of that section;
(b)“prescribed” means prescribed by, or determined in accordance with, regulations;
(c)“regulations” means regulations made by the Secretary of State with the consent of the Treasury.
(5)No regulations to which subsection (6) applies shall be made under this section unless a draft of the regulations has been laid before, and approved by a resolution of, each House of Parliament.
(6)This subsection applies to regulations under this section that—
(a)provide for a supplement to be payable in a case where one would not otherwise be payable,
(b)increase the amount of a supplement,
(c)provide for a supplement to become payable earlier than it would otherwise be payable, or
(d)provide for a supplement to be payable by a person by whom the supplement would not otherwise be payable.
(1)The Secretary of State may by regulations make provision for notifying the person in whose name a vehicle is registered under this Act about—
(a)any supplement under section 7A that may or has become payable on non-renewal of a vehicle licence for the vehicle;
(b)when failure to renew a vehicle licence may result in the person being guilty of an offence under section 31A.
(2)The Secretary of State may by regulations make provision—
(a)for assessing an amount of supplement due under section 7A from any person and for notifying that amount to that person or any person acting in a representative capacity in relation to that person;
(b)for an amount assessed and notified under such regulations to be deemed to be an amount of vehicle excise duty due from the person assessed and recoverable accordingly;
(c)for review of decisions under such regulations and for appeals with respect to such decisions or decisions on such reviews.
(3)Regulations under subsection (2) may, in particular, make provision that, subject to any modifications that the Secretary of State considers appropriate, corresponds or is similar to—
(a)any provision made by sections 12A and 12B of the Finance Act 1994 (assessments related to excise duty matters), or
(b)any provision made by sections 14 to 16 of that Act (customs and excise reviews and appeals).
(4)Sums received by way of supplements under section 7A shall be paid into the Consolidated Fund.”.
Commencement Information
I11Sch. 5 para. 5 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 5 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
6(1)In section 22 (registration regulations), in subsection (1D) (power to require details about unlicensed vehicles), after paragraph (a) insert—U.K.
“(aa)who does not renew a vehicle licence for a vehicle registered under this Act in his name,”.
(2)After that subsection insert—
“(1DA)For the purposes of subsection (1D)(aa) a person shall be regarded as not renewing a vehicle licence for a vehicle registered in his name if—
(a)a vehicle for which a vehicle licence is in force is registered in his name, and
(b)he does not, at such time as may be prescribed by the regulations or within such period as may be so prescribed, take out a vehicle licence to have effect from the expiry of the vehicle licence mentioned in paragraph (a).”.
Commencement Information
I12Sch. 5 para. 6 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 6 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
7U.K.In section 29(7) (rate of duty by reference to which penalty is calculated), for “section 2(2) to (4)" substitute “ section 2(3) to (6) ”.
Commencement Information
I13Sch. 5 para. 7 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 7 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
8U.K.After section 31 insert—
“Offence of being registered keeper of unlicensed vehicle
(1)If a vehicle registered under this Act is unlicensed, the person in whose name the vehicle is registered is guilty of an offence.
(2)For the purposes of this section a vehicle is unlicensed if no vehicle licence or trade licence is in force for or in respect of the vehicle.
(3)Subsection (1) does not apply to a vehicle if—
(a)it is an exempt vehicle in respect of which regulations under this Act require a nil licence to be in force and a nil licence is in force in respect of the vehicle, or
(b)it is an exempt vehicle that is not one in respect of which regulations under this Act require a nil licence to be in force.
(4)Where a vehicle for which a vehicle licence is in force is transferred by the holder of the licence to another person, the licence is to be treated for the purposes of subsection (2) as no longer in force unless it is delivered to the other person with the vehicle.
(5)Where—
(a)an application is made for a vehicle licence for any period, and
(b)a temporary licence is issued pursuant to the application,
subsection (4) does not apply to the licence applied for if, on a transfer of the vehicle during the currency of the temporary licence, the temporary licence is delivered with the vehicle to the transferee.
(1)A person (“the registered keeper”) in whose name an unlicensed vehicle is registered at any particular time (“the relevant time”) does not commit an offence under section 31A at that time if any of the following conditions are satisfied.
(2)The first condition is that the registered keeper—
(a)is not at the relevant time the person keeping the vehicle, and
(b)if previously he was the person keeping the vehicle, he has by the relevant time complied with any requirements under section 22(1)(d)—
(i)that are prescribed for the purposes of this condition, and
(ii)that he is required to have complied with by the relevant or any earlier time.
(3)The second condition is that—
(a)the registered keeper is at the relevant time the person keeping the vehicle,
(b)at the relevant time the vehicle is neither kept nor used on a public road, and
(c)the registered keeper has by the relevant time complied with any requirements under section 22(1D)—
(i)that are prescribed for the purposes of this condition, and
(ii)that he is required to have complied with by the relevant or any earlier time.
(4)The third condition is that—
(a)the vehicle has been stolen before the relevant time,
(b)the vehicle has not been recovered by the relevant time, and
(c)any requirements under subsection (6) that, in connection with the theft, are required to have been complied with by the relevant or any earlier time have been complied with by the relevant time.
(5)The fourth condition is that the relevant time falls within a period (“the grace days”)—
(a)beginning with the expiry of the last vehicle licence to be in force for the vehicle, and
(b)of a prescribed length,
and a vehicle licence for the vehicle is taken out within the grace days for a period beginning with the grace days.
(6)The Secretary of State may by regulations make provision for the purposes of subsection (4)(c) as to the persons to whom, the times at which and the manner in which the theft of a vehicle is to be notified.
(7)The Secretary of State may by regulations make provision amending this section for the purpose of providing for further exceptions to section 31A(1) (or varying or revoking any such further exceptions).
(8)A person accused of an offence under section 31A(1) is not entitled to the benefit of an exception conferred by or under this section unless evidence is adduced that is sufficient to raise an issue with respect to that exception, but where evidence is so adduced it is for the prosecution to prove beyond reasonable doubt that the exception does not apply.
(9)In this section—
(a)references to the expiry of a vehicle licence include a reference to—
(i)its surrender, and
(ii)its being treated as no longer in force for the purposes of subsection (2) of section 31A by subsection (4) of that section;
(b)“prescribed” means prescribed by regulations made by the Secretary of State.
(1)A person guilty of an offence under section 31A(1) is liable on summary conviction to—
(a)an excise penalty of—
(i)level 3 on the standard scale, or
(ii)five times the amount of vehicle excise duty chargeable in respect of the vehicle concerned,
whichever is the greater; and
(b)if subsection (3) applies to him, an excise penalty (in addition to any under paragraph (a)) of an amount that complies with subsection (2).
(2)An amount complies with this subsection if it—
(a)is not less than the greater of—
(i)the maximum of the penalty to which the person is liable under subsection (1)(a), and
(ii)the amount of the supplement (if any) that became payable by him by reason of non-renewal of the vehicle licence for the vehicle that last expired before the commission of the offence; and
(b)is not more than the greatest of—
(i)the maximum of the penalty to which the person is liable under subsection (1)(a),
(ii)the amount mentioned in paragraph (a)(ii), and
(iii)ten times the amount of vehicle excise duty chargeable in respect of the vehicle.
(3)This subsection applies to the person if—
(a)he was, at the time proceedings for the offence were commenced, the person in whose name the vehicle concerned was registered under this Act, and
(b)that vehicle was unlicensed throughout the period beginning with the commission of the offence and ending with the commencement of those proceedings.
(4)The amount of vehicle excise duty chargeable in respect of a vehicle is to be taken for the purposes of subsections (1) and (2) to be an amount equal to the annual rate of duty applicable to the vehicle at the date on which the offence was committed.
(5)Where in the case of a vehicle kept (but not used) on a public road that annual rate differs from the annual rate by reference to which the vehicle was at that date chargeable under section 2(3) to (6), the amount of the vehicle excise duty chargeable in respect of the vehicle is to be taken for those purposes to be an amount equal to the latter rate.
(6)In the case of a conviction for a continuing offence, the offence is to be taken for the purposes of subsections (4) and (5) to have been committed on the date or latest date to which the conviction relates.
(7)In this section, references to the expiry of a vehicle licence include a reference to—
(a)its surrender, and
(b)its being treated as no longer in force for the purposes of subsection (2) of section 31A by subsection (4) of that section.
Offences under sections 29 and 31A: supplementary”.
Commencement Information
I14Sch. 5 para. 8 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 8 in force at 19.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
9(1)In section 32 (sections 29 to 31: supplementary), in subsection (1) (discharges to be treated as convictions)—U.K.
(a)in the words before paragraph (a), after “section 29" insert “ or 31A ”, and
(b)in the words after paragraph (c), after “sections 29 to 31" insert “ or (as the case may be) sections 31A to 31C ”.
(2)In the heading of that section, for “31" substitute “ 31C ”.
Commencement Information
I15Sch. 5 para. 9 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 9 in force at 19.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
10U.K.In section 33(3)(b) (offences of not exhibiting licence are without prejudice to offences of not having a licence), after “sections 29" insert “ , 31A ”.
Commencement Information
I16Sch. 5 para. 10 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 10 in force at 19.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
11U.K.In section 34(4) (rate of duty by reference to which penalty is calculated), for “section 2(2) to (4)" substitute “ section 2(3) to (6) ”.
Commencement Information
I17Sch. 5 para. 11 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 11 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
12U.K.In section 47 (proceedings in England and Wales or Northern Ireland), in each of subsections (1) and (2)(a) (who may prosecute and time limit), after “section 29," insert “ 31A, ”.
Commencement Information
I18Sch. 5 para. 12 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 12 in force at 19.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
13U.K.In section 48(3)(a) (proceedings in Scotland: time limit), after “section 29," insert “ 31A, ”.
Commencement Information
I19Sch. 5 para. 13 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 13 in force at 19.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
14U.K.In section 53 (burden of proof of certain matters in proceedings for certain offences), after “section 29," insert “ 31A, ”.
Commencement Information
I20Sch. 5 para. 14 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 14 in force at 19.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
15U.K.In section 54 (single witness sufficient in Scottish proceedings), after “section 29" insert “ , 31A ”.
Commencement Information
I21Sch. 5 para. 15 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 15 in force at 19.12.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
16U.K.In section 57 (regulations), after subsection (7) insert—
“(7A)Subsection (7) does not apply to a statutory instrument containing regulations under section 7A to which subsection (6) of that section applies.”.
Commencement Information
I22Sch. 5 para. 16 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 16 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2
17U.K.In section 62(1) (definitions), for the definition of “vehicle" substitute—
““vehicle” shall be construed in accordance with section 1(1B);”.
Commencement Information
I23Sch. 5 para. 17 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes, see s. 19(2)(3); Sch. 5 para. 17 in force at 30.11.2003 in so far as not already in force by S.I. 2003/3086, art. 2; Sch. 5 para. 17 in force at 24.7.2002 for specified purposes , see s. 19(2)(3)
Section 37
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F3Sch. 6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 723(1)(a)(b) of the amending Act) by Income Tax (Earnings and Pensions) Act 2003 (c. 1), s. 723, Sch. 8 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 7)
Section 43
The following Schedule is inserted after Schedule 7AA to the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12)—
1(1)This Schedule sets out how sections 152 and 153 and other related enactments are modified for the purposes of section 179B (roll-over of degrouping charge on business assets).
(2)In the enactments as so modified—
“company A” and “company B” have the same meanings as in section 179;
“relevant asset” means the asset mentioned in section 179B(1);
“deemed sale” means the sale of the relevant asset that is treated as taking place by virtue of section 179(3) or (6);
“deemed sale consideration” means the amount for which company A is treated as having sold the relevant asset;
“time of accrual” means—
in a case where section 179(3) applies, the time at which, by virtue of section 179(4), the gain or loss accruing on the deemed sale is treated as accruing to company A;
in a case where section 179(6) applies, the latest time at which the company satisfies the conditions in section 179(7).
2(1)For subsection (1) of section 152 (roll-over relief) substitute—
“(1)If—
(a)company B was carrying on a trade at the time when it disposed of the relevant asset to company A,
(b)the relevant asset was used, and used only, for the purposes of that trade throughout the period when it was owned by company B,
(c)an amount that is not less than the deemed sale consideration is applied by company A in acquiring other assets, or an interest in other assets (“the new assets”),
(d)on acquisition the new assets are taken into use, and used only, for the purposes of a trade carried on by company A,
(e)both the relevant asset and the new assets are within the classes of assets listed in section 155, and
(f)company A makes a claim as respects the amount applied as mentioned in paragraph (c),
company A shall be treated for the purposes of this Act as if the deemed sale consideration were (if otherwise of a greater amount) reduced to such amount as would secure that neither a gain nor a loss accrues to the company in respect of the deemed sale.
(1A)Where subsection (1) applies, company A shall be treated for the purposes of this Act as if the amount or value of the consideration for the acquisition of, or of the interest in, the new assets were reduced by the same amount as the amount of the reduction under that subsection.
(1B)Subsection (1) does not affect the value at which company A is treated by virtue of section 179 as having reacquired the relevant asset.
(1C)Subsection (1A) does not affect the treatment for the purposes of this Act of the other party to the transaction involving the new assets. ".
(2)In subsection (2) of that section (application of subsection (1) where old assets held on 6th April 1965)—
(a)for “subsection (1)(a)" substitute “subsection (1)";
(b)for “subsection (1)(b)" substitute “subsection (1A)".
(3)In subsection (3) of that section (reinvestment period), for “after the disposal of, or of the interest in, the old assets" substitute “after the time of accrual".
(4)In subsection (5) of that section (new assets must be acquired for purposes of trade), for “the trade" substitute “the trade carried on by company A".
(5)In subsection (6) of that section (apportionment where part of building etc not used for purposes of trade), omit “or disposal" and insert at the end “or of the deemed sale consideration".
(6)After that subsection insert—
“(6A)In subsection (6) “period of ownership”, in relation to the relevant asset, means the period during which the asset was owned by company B. ".
(7)In subsection (7) of that section (apportionment where old assets not used for purposes of trade throughout period of ownership)—
(a)for the words from the beginning to “period of ownership" substitute “If the relevant asset was not used for the purposes of the trade carried on by company B throughout the period during which it was owned by that company";
(b)for the words from “or disposal" to the end substitute “of the asset or of the deemed sale consideration".
(8)In subsection (9) of that section (“period of ownership” does not include period before 31st March 1982), for “ “period of ownership" does not" substitute “the references to the period during which the relevant asset was owned by company B do not".
(9)In subsection (11) of that section (apportionment of consideration for assets not all of which are subject of claim), omit “or disposal" and insert at the end “; and similarly in relation to the deemed sale consideration".
3For subsection (1) of section 153 (assets only partly replaced) substitute—
“(1)If—
(a)an amount that is less than the deemed sale consideration is applied by company A in acquiring other assets, or an interest in other assets (“the new assets”),
(b)the difference between the deemed sale consideration and the amount so applied (“the shortfall”) is less than the amount of the gain (whether all chargeable gain or not) accruing on the deemed sale,
(c)the conditions in paragraphs (a), (b), (d) and (e) of section 152(1) are satisfied, and
(d)company A makes a claim as respects the amount applied as mentioned in paragraph (a) above,
company A shall be treated for the purposes of this Act as if the amount of the gain accruing as mentioned in paragraph (b) above were reduced to the same amount as the shortfall (with a proportionate reduction, if not all of that gain is chargeable gain, in the amount of the chargeable gain).
(1A)Where subsection (1) applies, company A shall be treated for the purposes of this Act as if the amount or value of the consideration for the acquisition of, or of the interest in, the new assets were reduced by the amount by which the gain is reduced (or as the case may be the amount by which the chargeable gain is proportionately reduced) under that subsection.
(1B)Subsection (1) does not affect the value at which company A is treated by virtue of section 179 as having reacquired the relevant asset.
(1C)Subsection (1A) does not affect the treatment for the purposes of this Act of the other party to the transaction involving the new assets. ".
4(1)In subsection (1) of section 153A (provisional application of sections 152 and 153)—
(a)for the words from “a person" to “takes place" substitute “company A declares, in its return for the chargeable period in which the time of accrual falls";
(b)for “the trade" substitute “a trade carried on by company A";
(c)for “the whole or any specified part of the consideration" substitute “an amount equal to the deemed sale consideration or any specified part of that amount".
(2)In subsection (5) of that section (meaning of “relevant day"), for paragraphs (a) and (b) substitute “the fourth anniversary of the last day of the accounting period of company A in which the time of accrual falls".
5In section 155 (relevant classes of assets), in Head A of Class 1, after paragraph 2 insert— “In Head A “the trade” means—
(a)for the purposes of determining whether the relevant asset is within this head, the trade carried on by company B;
(b)for the purposes of determining whether the new assets are within this head, the trade carried on by company A. ".
6(1)In subsection (1) of section 159 (new assets must be chargeable assets), for the words from “in the case of a person" to the second “in relation to him" substitute “if the relevant asset (or, as the case may be, the property mentioned in section 179(3)(b)) is a chargeable asset in relation to company A at the time of accrual, unless the new assets are chargeable assets in relation to that company".
(2)In subsection (2) of that section (subsection (1) not to apply where new assets acquired by UK resident after disposal of old ones)—
(a)for paragraph (a) substitute—
“(a)company A acquires the new assets after the time of accrual, and ";
(b)in paragraph (b) for “the person" substitute “that company".
(3)In subsection (3) of that section (subsection (2) not to apply in certain cases where new assets acquired by dual resident), for “the person" substitute “company A".
(4)In subsection (6) of that section (definitions)—
(a)in paragraph (a) for “ “the old assets" and “the new assets" have the same meanings" substitute “ “the new assets" has the same meaning";
(b)omit paragraph (b).
(5)Omit subsection (7) of that section (acquisitions before 14th March 1989).
7(1)In subsection (2) of section 175 (single-trade rule for group members not to apply in case of dual resident investing company)—
(a)for “the consideration for the disposal of the old assets" substitute “the amount of the deemed sale consideration";
(b)for “ “the old assets" and “the new assets" have the same meanings" substitute “ “the new assets" has the same meaning".
(2)In subsection (2A) of that section (claim by two group members to be treated as same person for roll-over purposes), for paragraph (a) substitute—
“(a)company A is a member of a group of companies at the time of accrual, ".
(3)In subsection (2AA) of that section (conditions for claim under subsection (2A))—
(a)in paragraph (a) for the words from the beginning to “chargeable assets" substitute “that company A is resident in the United Kingdom at the time of accrual, or the relevant asset (or, as the case may be, the property mentioned in section 179(3)(b)) is a chargeable asset"
(b)in paragraph (b) for “the assets" substitute “the new assets (within the meaning of section 152)".
(4)Immediately before subsection (2B) of that section (roll-over relief for group member not itself carrying on trade) insert—
“(2AB)Section 152 or 153 shall apply where—
(a)company B was not carrying on a trade at the time when it disposed of the relevant asset to company A, but was a member of a group of companies at that time, and
(b)immediately before that time the relevant asset was used, and used only, for the purposes of the trade which (in accordance with subsection (1) above) is treated as carried on by the members of the group which carried on a trade,
as if company B had been carrying on that trade. ".
(5)In subsection (2B) of that section—
(a)omit paragraph (a);
(b)in paragraph (b), for “those purposes" substitute “the purposes of the trade which (in accordance with subsection (1) above) is treated as carried on by the members of the group which carry on a trade".
(6)Omit subsection (4) of that section (acquisitions before 20th March 1990).
8(1)In subsection (3) of section 185 (no roll-over relief in certain cases where company acquires new assets after becoming non-resident)—
(a)omit “the company";
(b)for paragraph (a) substitute—
“(a)the time of accrual falls before the relevant time; and ";
(c)insert “the company" at the beginning of paragraph (b).
(2)In subsection (5) of that section (definitions), in paragraph (c) for “ “the old assets" and “the new assets" have the same meanings" substitute “ “the new assets" has the same meaning".
9(1)For subsection (1) of section 198 (replacement of business assets used in connection with oil fields) substitute—
“(1)If at the time of accrual the relevant asset (or, as the case may be, the property mentioned in section 179(3)(b)) was used by company A for the purposes of a ring fence trade carried on by it, section 152 or 153 shall not apply unless the new assets are on acquisition taken into use, and used only, for the purposes of that trade. ".
(2)In subsection (3) of that section (new asset conclusively presumed to be depreciating asset), for “in relation to any of the consideration on a material disposal" substitute “in a case falling within subsection (1) above".
(3)In subsection (5) of that section (definitions), omit paragraph (a).
10In sub-paragraph (2) of paragraph 67 of Schedule 22 to the Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) (no roll-over relief for tonnage tax assets)—
(a)after “the disposal", in the first and third places, insert “or deemed sale";
(b)in paragraph (a) after “Asset No.1" insert “or, as the case may be, the deemed sale consideration".”.
Section 44(2)
1U.K.The following Schedule is inserted after Schedule 7AB to the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12)—
1(1)A gain accruing to a company (“the investing company”) on a disposal of shares or an interest in shares in another company (“the company invested in”) is not a chargeable gain if the requirements of this Schedule are met.
(2)The requirements are set out in—
Part 2 (the substantial shareholding requirement), and
Part 3 (requirements to be met in relation to the investing company and the company invested in).
(3)The exemption conferred by this paragraph does not apply in the circumstances specified in paragraph 5 or the cases specified in paragraph 6.
2(1)A gain accruing to a company (“company A”) on a disposal of an asset related to shares in another company (“company B”) is not a chargeable gain if either of the following conditions is met.
(2)The first condition is that—
(a)immediately before the disposal company A holds shares or an interest in shares in company B, and
(b)any gain accruing to company A on a disposal at that time of the shares or interest would, by virtue of paragraph 1, not be a chargeable gain.
(3)The second condition is that—
(a)immediately before the disposal company A does not hold shares or an interest in shares in company B but is a member of a group and another member of that group does hold shares or an interest in shares in company B, and
(b)if company A, rather than that other company, held the shares or interest, any gain accruing to company A on a disposal at that time of the shares or interest would, by virtue of paragraph 1, not be a chargeable gain.
(4)Where assets of a company are vested in a liquidator under section 145 of the Insolvency Act 1986 or Article 123 of the Insolvency (Northern Ireland) Order 1989 or otherwise, this paragraph applies as if the assets were vested in, and the acts of the liquidator in relation to the assets were the acts of, the company (acquisitions from or disposals to him by the company being disregarded accordingly).
(5)The exemption conferred by this paragraph does not apply in the circumstances specified in paragraph 5 or the cases specified in paragraph 6.
3(1)A gain accruing to a company (“company A”) on a disposal of shares, or an interest in shares or an asset related to shares, in another company (“company B”) is not a chargeable gain if the following conditions are met.
(2)The conditions are—
(a)that at the time of the disposal company A meets the requirement in paragraph 7 (the substantial shareholding requirement) in relation to company B;
(b)that a chargeable gain or allowable loss would, apart from this paragraph, accrue to company A on the disposal (but see sub-paragraph (3) below);
(c)that at the time of the disposal—
(i)company A is resident in the United Kingdom, or
(ii)any chargeable gain accruing to company A on the disposal would, by virtue of section 10(3), form part of that company’s chargeable profits for corporation tax purposes;
(d)that there was a time within the period of two years ending with the disposal (“the relevant period”) when, if—
(i)company A, or
(ii)a company that at any time in the relevant period was a member of the same group as company A,
had disposed of shares or an interest in shares in company B that it then held, a gain accruing would, by virtue of paragraph 1, not have been a chargeable gain; and
(e)that, if at the time of the disposal the requirements of paragraph 19 (requirements relating to company invested in) are not met in relation to company B, there was a time within the relevant period when company B was controlled by—
(i)company A, or
(ii)company A together with any persons connected with it, or
(iii)a company that at any time in the relevant period was a member of the same group as company A, or
(iv)any such company together with any persons connected with it.
(3)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply if—
(a)the condition in sub-paragraph (2)(b) is met but would not be met but for a failure to meet the requirement in paragraph 18(1)(b) (requirement as to investing company to be met immediately after the disposal), and
(b)the failure to meet that requirement is not due to—
(i)the fact that company A has been wound up or dissolved, or
(ii)where the winding up or dissolution takes place as soon as is reasonably practicable in the circumstances, the fact that company A is about to be wound up or dissolved.
(4)In determining for the purpose of sub-paragraph (2)(d) whether a gain accruing on the hypothetical disposal referred to would have been a chargeable gain, the requirements of paragraph 18(1)(b) and of paragraph 19(1)(b) (requirement as to company invested in to be met immediately after the disposal) shall be assumed to be met.
(5)Where—
(a)immediately before the disposal company B holds an asset,
(b)the expenditure allowable in computing any gain or loss on that asset, were it to be disposed of by company B immediately before that disposal, would fall to be reduced because of a claim to relief under section 165 (gifts relief) in relation to an earlier disposal, and
(c)that earlier disposal took place within the relevant period,
sub-paragraph (1) does not prevent a gain accruing to company A on the disposal from being a chargeable gain but any loss so accruing is not an allowable loss.
(6)Where assets of company B are vested in a liquidator under section 145 of the Insolvency Act 1986 or Article 123 of the Insolvency (Northern Ireland) Order 1989 or otherwise, sub-paragraph (5)(a) applies as if the assets were vested in the company.
(7)In determining “the relevant period” for the purposes of sub-paragraph (2)(d) or (e) or sub-paragraph (5)(c), section 28 (time of disposal under contract) applies with the omission of subsection (2) (postponement of time of disposal in case of conditional contract).
(8)The exemption conferred by this paragraph does not apply in the circumstances specified in paragraph 5 or the cases specified in paragraph 6.
4(1)For the purposes of determining whether an exemption conferred by this Schedule applies, the question whether there is a disposal shall be determined without regard to—
(a)section 116(10) (reorganisation, conversion of securities, etc treated as not involving disposal),
(b)section 127 (share reorganisations etc treated as not involving disposal), or
(c)section 192(2)(a) (distribution not treated as capital distribution).
(2)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply to a disposal of shares if the effect of its applying would be that relief attributable to the shares under Schedule 15 to the Finance Act 2000 (corporate venturing scheme) would be withdrawn or reduced under paragraph 46 of that Schedule (withdrawal or reduction of investment relief on disposal of shares).
(3)Where or to the extent that an exemption conferred by this Schedule does apply—
(a)the provisions mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(a) and (b) do not apply in relation to the disposal, and
(b)the provision mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(c) does not apply in relation to the subject matter of the disposal.
(4)Where section 127 is disapplied by sub-paragraph (3)(a) in a case in which that section would otherwise have applied in relation to the disposal by virtue of paragraph 84 of Schedule 15 to the Finance Act 2000 (corporate venturing scheme: share exchanges), paragraph 85 of that Schedule (attribution of relief to new shares) does not apply.
(5)In this paragraph any reference to section 127 includes a reference to that provision as applied by any enactment relating to corporation tax.
5(1)Where in pursuance of arrangements to which this paragraph applies—
(a)an untaxed gain accrues to a company (“company A”) on a disposal of shares, or an interest in shares or an asset related to shares, in another company (“company B”), and
(b)before the accrual of that gain—
(i)company A acquired control of company B, or the same person or persons acquired control of both companies, or
(ii)there was a significant change of trading activities affecting company B at a time when it was controlled by company A, or when both companies were controlled by the same person or persons,
none of the exemptions in this Schedule applies to the disposal.
(2)This paragraph applies to arrangements from which the sole or main benefit that (but for this paragraph) could be expected to arise is that the gain on the disposal would, by virtue of this Schedule, not be a chargeable gain.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(a) a gain is “untaxed” if the gain, or all of it but a part that is not substantial, represents profits that have not been brought into account (in the United Kingdom or elsewhere) for the purposes of tax on profits for a period ending on or before the date of the disposal.
(4)The reference in sub-paragraph (3) to profits being brought into account for the purposes of tax on profits includes a reference to the case where—
(a)an amount in respect of those profits is apportioned to a company resident in the United Kingdom by virtue of subsection (3) of section 747 of the Taxes Act 1988 (imputation of chargeable profits etc of controlled foreign companies), and
(b)a sum is chargeable on that company in respect of that amount by virtue of subsection (4) of that section for an accounting period of that company ending on or before the date of the disposal.
(5)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(b)(ii) there is a “significant change of trading activities affecting company B” if—
(a)there is a major change in the nature or conduct of a trade carried on by company B or a 51% subsidiary of company B, or
(b)there is a major change in the scale of the activities of a trade carried on by company B or a 51% subsidiary of company B, or
(c)company B or a 51% subsidiary of company B begins to carry on a trade.
(6)In this paragraph—
“arrangements” includes any scheme, agreement or understanding, whether or not legally enforceable;
“major change in the nature or conduct of a trade” has the same meaning as in section 768 of the Taxes Act (change of ownership of company: disallowance of trading losses);
“profits” means income or gains (including unrealised income or gains).
6(1)The exemptions conferred by this Schedule do not apply—
(a)to a disposal that by virtue of any enactment relating to chargeable gains is deemed to be for a consideration such that no gain or loss accrues to the person making the disposal,
(b)to a disposal a gain on which would, by virtue of any enactment not contained in this Schedule, not be a chargeable gain, or
(c)to a deemed disposal under section 440(1) or (2) of the Taxes Act (deemed disposal on transfer of asset of insurance company from one category to another).
(2)The hypothetical disposal referred to in paragraph 2(2)(b) or (3)(b) or paragraph 3(2)(d) shall be assumed not to be a disposal within sub-paragraph (1)(a), (b) or (c) above.
Part 2The substantial shareholding requirement
7The investing company must have held a substantial shareholding in the company invested in throughout a twelve-month period beginning not more than two years before the day on which the disposal takes place.
8(1)For the purposes of this Schedule a company holds a “substantial shareholding” in another company if it holds shares or interests in shares in that company by virtue of which—
(a)it holds not less than 10% of the company’s ordinary share capital,
(b)it is beneficially entitled to not less than 10% of the profits available for distribution to equity holders of the company, and
(c)it would be beneficially entitled on a winding up to not less than 10% of the assets of the company available for distribution to equity holders.
This is without prejudice to what is meant by “substantial” where the word appears in other contexts.
(2)Schedule 18 to the Taxes Act 1988 (meaning of equity holder and determination of profits or assets available for distribution) applies for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1).
(3)In that Schedule as it applies for those purposes—
(a)for any reference to sections 403C and 413(7) of that Act, or either of those provisions, substitute a reference to sub-paragraph (1) above;
(b)omit the words in paragraph 1(4) from “but" to the end;
(c)omit paragraph 5(3) and paragraphs 5B to 5F; and
(d)omit paragraph 7(1)(b).
9(1)For the purposes of paragraph 7 (the substantial shareholding requirement) a company that is a member of a group is treated—
(a)as holding any shares or interest in shares held by any other company in the group, and
(b)as having the same entitlement as any such company to any rights enjoyed by virtue of holding shares or an interest in shares.
(2)Sub-paragraph (1) is subject to paragraph 17(4) (exclusion of aggregation in case of assets of long-term insurance fund of insurance company).
10(1)For the purposes of this Part the period for which a company has held shares is treated as extended by any earlier period during which the shares concerned, or shares from which they are derived, were held—
(a)by a company from which the shares concerned were transferred to the first-mentioned company on a no-gain/ no-loss transfer, or
(b)by a company from which the shares concerned, or shares from which they are derived, were transferred on a previous no-gain/no-loss transfer—
(i)to a company within paragraph (a), or
(ii)to another company within this paragraph.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)—
(a)a “no-gain/no-loss transfer” means a disposal and corresponding acquisition that by virtue of any enactment relating to chargeable gains are deemed to be for a consideration such that no gain or loss accrues to the person making the disposal;
(b)a transfer shall be treated as if it had been a no-gain/no- loss transfer if it is a transfer to which subsection (1) of section 171 (transfers within a group) would apply but for subsection (3) of that section.
(3)Where sub-paragraph (1) applies to extend the period for which a company (“company A”) is treated as having held any shares, that company shall be treated for the purposes of this Part as having had at any time the same entitlement—
(a)to shares, and
(b)to any rights enjoyed by virtue of holding shares,
as the company (“company B”) that at that time held the shares concerned or, as the case may be, the shares from which they are derived.
(4)The shares and rights to be so attributed to company A include any holding or entitlement attributed at that time to company B under paragraph 9 (aggregation of holdings of group companies).
(5)In this paragraph, except in paragraphs (a) to (c) of sub-paragraph (6), “shares” includes an interest in shares.
(6)For the purposes of this paragraph shares are “derived” from other shares only where—
(a)a company becomes a co-owner of shares previously owned by it alone, or vice versa,
(b)a company’s interest in shares as co-owner changes (without the company ceasing to be a co-owner),
(c)one holding of shares is treated by virtue of section 127 as the same asset as another, or
(d)there is a sequence of two or more of the occurrences mentioned in paragraphs (a) to (c).
The reference in paragraph (c) to section 127 includes a reference to that provision as applied by any enactment relating to corporation tax.
11(1)For the purposes of this Part a company is not regarded as having held shares throughout a period if, at any time during that period, there is a deemed disposal and reacquisition of—
(a)the shares concerned, or
(b)shares, or an interest in shares, from which those shares are derived.
(2)For the purposes of this Part a company is not regarded as having held an interest in shares throughout a period if, at any time during that period, there is a deemed disposal and reacquisition of—
(a)the interest concerned, or
(b)shares, or an interest in shares, from which that interest is derived.
(3)In this paragraph—
“deemed disposal and reacquisition” means a disposal and immediate reacquisition treated as taking place under any enactment relating to corporation tax;
“derived” has the same meaning as in paragraph 10.
12(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)a company that holds shares in another company transfers the shares under a repurchase agreement, and
(b)by virtue of section 263A(1) (agreements for sale and repurchase of securities) the disposal is disregarded for the purposes of the enactments relating to chargeable gains.
(2)During the period of the repurchase agreement—
(a)the original owner shall be treated for the purposes of this Part as continuing to hold the shares transferred and accordingly as retaining his entitlement to any rights attached to them, and
(b)the interim holder shall be treated for those purposes as not holding the shares transferred and as not becoming entitled to any such rights.
This is subject to the following qualification.
(3)If at any time before the end of the period of the repurchase agreement the original owner, or another member of the same group as the original owner, becomes the holder—
(a)of any of the shares transferred, or
(b)of any shares directly or indirectly representing any of the shares transferred,
sub-paragraph (2) does not apply after that time in relation to those shares or, as the case may be, in relation to the shares represented by those shares.
(4)In this paragraph a “repurchase agreement” means an agreement under which—
(a)a person (“the original owner”) transfers shares to another person (“the interim holder”) under an agreement to sell them, and
(b)the original owner or a person connected with him is required to buy them back either—
(i)in pursuance of an obligation to do so imposed by that agreement or by any related agreement, or
(ii)in consequence of the exercise of an option acquired under that agreement or any related agreement.
For the purposes of paragraph (b) agreements are related if they are entered into in pursuance of the same arrangements (regardless of the date on which either agreement is entered into).
(5)Any reference in this paragraph to the period of a repurchase agreement is to the period beginning with the transfer of the shares by the original owner to the interim holder and ending with the repurchase of the shares in pursuance of the agreement.
13(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)a company that holds shares in another company transfers the shares under a stock lending arrangement, and
(b)by virtue of section 263B(2) (stock lending arrangements) the disposal is disregarded for the purposes of the enactments relating to chargeable gains.
(2)During the period of the stock lending arrangement—
(a)the lender shall be treated for the purposes of this Part as continuing to hold the shares transferred and accordingly as retaining his entitlement to any rights attached to them, and
(b)the borrower shall be treated for those purposes as not holding the shares transferred and as not becoming entitled to any such rights.
This is subject to the following qualification.
(3)If at any time before the end of the period of the stock lending arrangement the lender, or another member of the same group as the lender, becomes the holder—
(a)of any of the shares transferred, or
(b)of any shares directly or indirectly representing any of the shares transferred,
sub-paragraph (2) does not apply after that time in relation to those shares or, as the case may be, in relation to the shares represented by those shares.
(4)In this paragraph a “stock lending arrangement” means arrangements between two persons (“the borrower” and “the lender”) under which—
(a)the lender transfers shares to the borrower otherwise than by way of sale, and
(b)a requirement is imposed on the borrower to transfer those shares back to the lender otherwise than by way of sale.
(5)Any reference in this paragraph to the period of a stock lending arrangement is to the period beginning with the transfer of the shares by the lender to the borrower and ending—
(a)with the transfer of the shares back to the lender in pursuance of the arrangement, or
(b)when it becomes apparent that the requirement for the borrower to make a transfer back to the lender will not be complied with.
(6)The following provisions apply for the purposes of this paragraph as they apply for the purposes of section 263B—
(a)subsections (5) and (6) of that section (references to transfer back of securities to include transfer of other securities of the same description);
(b)section 263C (references to transfer back of securities to include payment in respect of redemption).
14(1)This paragraph applies where shares in one company (“company X”)—
(a)are exchanged (or deemed to be exchanged) for shares in another company (“company Y”), or
(b)are deemed to be exchanged by virtue of section 136 for shares in company X and shares in another company (“company Y”),
in circumstances such that, under section 127 as that section applies by virtue of section 135 or 136, the original shares and the new holding are treated as the same asset.
(2)Where company Y—
(a)is the company invested in, and is accordingly the company by reference to which the requirement of paragraph 7 (the substantial shareholding requirement) falls to be met, or
(b)is a company by reference to which, by virtue of this paragraph, that requirement may be met, or
(c)is a company by reference to which, by virtue of paragraph 15 (effect of earlier demerger) that requirement may be met,
that requirement may instead be met, in relation to times before the exchange (or deemed exchange), by reference to company X.
(3)If in any case that requirement can be met by virtue of this paragraph (or by virtue of this paragraph together with paragraph 15), it shall be treated as met.
(4)In sub-paragraph (1) “original shares” and “new holding” shall be construed in accordance with sections 126, 127, 135 and 136.
15(1)This paragraph applies where shares in one company (“the subsidiary”) are transferred by another company (“the parent company”) on a demerger.
(2)Where the subsidiary—
(a)is the company invested in, and is accordingly the company by reference to which the requirement of paragraph 7 (the substantial shareholding requirement) falls to be met, or
(b)is a company by reference to which, by virtue of this paragraph, that requirement may be met, or
(c)is a company by reference to which, by virtue of paragraph 14 (effect of earlier company reconstruction etc), that requirement may be met,
that requirement may instead be met, in relation to times before the transfer, by reference to the parent company.
(3)If in any case that requirement can be met by virtue of this paragraph (or by virtue of this paragraph together with paragraph 14), it shall be treated as met.
(4)In this paragraph a “transfer of shares on a demerger” means a transfer such that, by virtue of section 192(2)(b), sections 126 to 130 apply as if the parent company and the subsidiary were the same company and the transfer were a reorganisation of that company’s share capital not involving a disposal or acquisition.
16Where assets of the investing company, or of a company that is a member of the same group as the investing company, are vested in a liquidator under section 145 of the Insolvency Act 1986 or Article 123 of the Insolvency (Northern Ireland) Order 1989 or otherwise, this Part applies as if the assets were vested in, and the acts of the liquidator in relation to the assets were the acts of, the company (acquisitions from or disposals to him by the company being disregarded accordingly).
17(1)In the following two cases paragraph 8(1) (meaning of substantial shareholding) has effect as if, in paragraphs (a), (b) and (c), “30%" were substituted for “10%".
(2)The first case is where the investing company is an insurance company and the disposal is of an asset of its long-term insurance fund.
(3)The second case is where—
(a)the investing company is a 51% subsidiary of an insurance company, and
(b)the insurance company holds as an asset of its long-term insurance fund shares or an interest in shares—
(i)in the investing company, or
(ii)in another company through which it owns shares in the investing company.
The reference in paragraph (b)(ii) to owning shares through another company has the same meaning as in section 838 of the Taxes Act (subsidiaries).
(4)Where the investing company is a member of a group that includes an insurance company, paragraph 9 (aggregation of holdings of group companies) does not apply in relation to shares or an interest in shares held by the insurance company as assets of its long-term insurance fund.
(5)In this paragraph “insurance company” and “long-term insurance fund” have the meanings given by section 431(2) of the Taxes Act.
Part 3Requirements to be met in relation to investing company and company invested in
18(1)The investing company must—
(a)have been a sole trading company or a member of a qualifying group throughout the period (“the qualifying period”)—
(i)beginning with the start of the latest twelve-month period by reference to which the requirement of paragraph 7 (the substantial shareholding requirement) is met, and
(ii)ending with the time of the disposal, and
(b)be a sole trading company or a member of a qualifying group immediately after the time of the disposal.
(2)For this purpose a “qualifying group” means—
(a)a trading group, or
(b)a group that would be a trading group if the activities of any group member that is not established for profit were disregarded to the extent that they are carried on otherwise than for profit.
In determining whether a company is established for profit, no account shall be taken of any object or power of the company that is only incidental to its main objects.
(3)The requirement in sub-paragraph (1)(a) is met if the investing company was a sole trading company for some of the qualifying period and a member of a qualifying group for the remainder of that period.
(4)The requirement in sub-paragraph (1)(a) is treated as met if at the time of the disposal—
(a)the investing company is a member of a group, and
(b)there is another member of the group in relation to which that requirement would have been met if—
(i)the subject matter of the disposal had been transferred to it immediately before the disposal in circumstances in which section 171(1) (transfers within a group) applied, and
(ii)it had made the disposal.
(5)If the disposal is by virtue of section 28(1) or (2) (asset disposed of under contract) treated as made at a time before the asset is conveyed or transferred, the requirements in sub-paragraph (1)(a) and (b) must also be complied with as they would have effect if the references in those provisions and sub-paragraph (4) to the time of the disposal were to the time of the conveyance or transfer.
(6)In this paragraph a “sole trading company” means a trading company that is not a member of a group.
19(1)The company invested in must—
(a)have been a qualifying company throughout the period—
(i)beginning with the start of the latest twelve-month period by reference to which the requirement of paragraph 7 (the substantial shareholding requirement) is met, and
(ii)ending with the time of the disposal, and
(b)be a qualifying company immediately after the time of the disposal.
(2)For this purpose a “qualifying company” means a trading company or the holding company of a trading group or a trading subgroup.
(3)If the disposal is by virtue of section 28(1) or (2) (asset disposed of under contract) treated as made at a time before the asset is conveyed or transferred, the requirements in sub-paragraph (1)(a) and (b) must also be complied with as they would have effect if the references there to the time of the disposal were to the time of the conveyance or transfer.
20(1)In this Schedule “trading company” means a company carrying on trading activities whose activities do not include to a substantial extent activities other than trading activities.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) “trading activities” means activities carried on by the company—
(a)in the course of, or for the purposes of, a trade being carried on by it,
(b)for the purposes of a trade that it is preparing to carry on,
(c)with a view to its acquiring or starting to carry on a trade, or
(d)with a view to its acquiring a significant interest in the share capital of another company that—
(i)is a trading company or the holding company of a trading group or trading subgroup, and
(ii)if the acquiring company is a member of a group, is not a member of that group.
(3)Activities do not qualify as trading activities under sub-paragraph (2)(c) or (d) unless the acquisition is made, or (as the case may be) the company starts to carry on the trade, as soon as is reasonably practicable in the circumstances.
(4)The reference in sub-paragraph (2)(d) to the acquisition of a significant interest in the share capital of another company is to an acquisition of ordinary share capital in the other company—
(a)such as would make that company a 51% subsidiary of the acquiring company, or
(b)such as would give the acquiring company a qualifying shareholding in a joint venture company without making the two companies members of the same group.
21(1)In this Schedule “trading group” means a group—
(a)one or more of whose members carry on trading activities, and
(b)the activities of whose members, taken together, do not include to a substantial extent activities other than trading activities.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) “trading activities” means activities carried on by a member of the group—
(a)in the course of, or for the purposes of, a trade being carried on by any member of the group,
(b)for the purposes of a trade that any member of the group is preparing to carry on,
(c)with a view to any member of the group acquiring or starting to carry on a trade, or
(d)with a view to any member of the group acquiring a significant interest in the share capital of another company that—
(i)is a trading company or the holding company of a trading group or trading subgroup, and
(ii)is not a member of the same group as the acquiring company.
(3)Activities do not qualify as trading activities under sub-paragraph (2)(c) or (d) unless the acquisition is made, or (as the case may be) the group member in question starts to carry on the trade, as soon as is reasonably practicable in the circumstances.
(4)The reference in sub-paragraph (2)(d) to the acquisition of a significant interest in the share capital of another company is to an acquisition of ordinary share capital in the other company—
(a)such as would make that company a member of the same group as the acquiring company, or
(b)such as would give the acquiring company a qualifying shareholding in a joint venture company without making the joint venture company a member of the same group as the acquiring company.
(5)For the purposes of this paragraph the activities of the members of the group shall be treated as one business (with the result that activities are disregarded to the extent that they are intra-group activities).
22(1)In this Schedule “trading subgroup” means a subgroup—
(a)one or more of whose members carry on trading activities, and
(b)the activities of whose members, taken together, do not include to a substantial extent activities other than trading activities.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) “trading activities” means activities carried on by a member of the subgroup—
(a)in the course of, or for the purposes of, a trade being carried on by any member of the subgroup,
(b)for the purposes of a trade that any member of the subgroup is preparing to carry on,
(c)with a view to any member of the subgroup acquiring or starting to carry on a trade, or
(d)with a view to any member of the subgroup acquiring a significant interest in the share capital of another company that—
(i)is a trading company or the holding company of a trading group or trading subgroup, and
(ii)is not a member of the same group as the acquiring company.
(3)Activities do not qualify as trading activities under sub-paragraph (2)(c) or (d) unless the acquisition is made, or (as the case may be) the subgroup member in question starts to carry on the trade, as soon as is reasonably practicable in the circumstances.
(4)The reference in sub-paragraph (2)(d) to the acquisition of a significant interest in the share capital of another company is to an acquisition of ordinary share capital in the other company—
(a)such as would make that company a member of the same subgroup as the acquiring company, or
(b)such as would give the acquiring company a qualifying shareholding in a joint venture company without making the two companies members of the same group.
(5)For the purposes of this paragraph the activities of the members of the subgroup shall be treated as one business (with the result that activities are disregarded to the extent that they are intra-subgroup activities).
23(1)This paragraph applies where a company (“the company”) has a qualifying shareholding in a joint venture company.
(2)In determining whether the company is a trading company—
(a)its holding of shares in the joint venture company shall be disregarded, and
(b)it shall be treated as carrying on an appropriate proportion—
(i)of the activities of the joint venture company, or
(ii)where the joint venture company is a holding company, of the activities of that company and its 51% subsidiaries.
This sub-paragraph does not apply if the company is a member of a group and the joint venture company is a member of the same group.
(3)In determining whether the company is a member of a trading group or the holding company of a trading group—
(a)every holding of shares in the joint venture company by a member of the group having a qualifying shareholding in that company shall be disregarded, and
(b)each member of the group having a qualifying shareholding in the joint venture company shall be treated as carrying on an appropriate proportion—
(i)of the activities of the joint venture company, or
(ii)where the joint venture company is a holding company, of the activities of that company and its 51% subsidiaries.
This sub-paragraph does not apply if the joint venture company is a member of the group.
(4)In determining whether the company is the holding company of a trading subgroup—
(a)every holding of shares in the joint venture company by the company and any of its 51% subsidiaries having a qualifying shareholding in the joint venture company shall be disregarded, and
(b)the company and each of its 51% subsidiaries having a qualifying shareholding in the joint venture company shall be treated as carrying on an appropriate proportion—
(i)of the activities of the joint venture company, or
(ii)where the joint venture company is a holding company, of the activities of that company and its 51% subsidiaries.
This sub-paragraph does not apply if the joint venture company is a member of the same group as the company.
(5)In sub-paragraphs (2)(b), (3)(b) and (4)(b) “an appropriate proportion” means a proportion corresponding to the percentage of the ordinary share capital of the joint venture company held by the company concerned.
(6)In this paragraph “shares”, in relation to a joint venture company, includes securities of that company or an interest in shares in or securities of that company.
(7)For the purposes of this paragraph the activities of a joint venture company that is a holding company and its 51% subsidiaries shall be treated as a single business (so that activities are disregarded to the extent that they are intra-group activities or, as the case may be, intra-subgroup activities).
24(1)For the purposes of this Schedule a company is a “joint venture company” if, and only if—
(a)it is a trading company or the holding company of a trading group or trading subgroup, and
(b)there are five or fewer persons who between them hold 75% or more of its ordinary share capital.
In determining whether there are five or fewer such persons as are mentioned in paragraph (b), the members of a group are treated as if they were a single company.
(2)For the purposes of this Schedule—
(a)a company that is not a member of a group has a “qualifying shareholding” in a joint venture company if, and only if, it holds shares or an interest in shares in the joint venture company by virtue of which it holds 10% or more of that company’s ordinary share capital;
(b)a company that is a member of a group has a “qualifying shareholding” in a joint venture company if, and only if—
(i)it holds ordinary share capital of the joint venture company, and
(ii)the members of the group between them hold 10% or more of the ordinary share capital of that company.
25The provisions of—
(a)paragraph 14 (effect of earlier company reconstruction etc), and
(b)paragraph 15 (effect of earlier demerger),
have effect in relation to the requirements of paragraph 19 (requirements in relation to company invested in) as they have effect in relation to the requirement of paragraph 7 (the substantial shareholding requirement).
Part 4Interpretation
26(1)In this Schedule—
(a)“company” has the meaning given by section 170(9); and
(b)references to a group, or to membership of a group, shall be construed in accordance with the provisions of section 170 read as if “51 per cent" were substituted for “75 per cent".
(2)References in this Schedule to a “subgroup” are to companies that would form a group but for the fact that one of them is a 51% subsidiary of another company.
(3)In this Schedule “holding company”—
(a)in relation to a group, means the company described in section 170 as the principal company of the group;
(b)in relation to a subgroup, means a company that would be the holding company of a group but for being a 51% subsidiary of another company.
(4)In this Schedule “51% subsidiary” has the meaning given by section 838 of the Taxes Act.
In applying that section for the purposes of this Schedule, any share capital of a registered industrial and provident society shall be treated as ordinary share capital.
(5)References in this Schedule to a “group” or “subsidiary” shall be construed with any necessary modifications where applied to a company incorporated under the law of a country or territory outside the United Kingdom.
27In this Schedule “trade” means anything that—
(a)is a trade, profession or vocation, within the meaning of the Income Tax Acts, and
(b)is conducted on a commercial basis with a view to the realisation of profits.
28For the purposes of this Schedule a “twelve-month period” means a period ending with the day before the first anniversary of the day with which, or in the course of which, the period began.
29(1)References in this Schedule to an interest in shares are to an interest as a co-owner of shares.
(2)It does not matter whether the shares are owned jointly or in common, or whether the interests of the co-owners are equal.
30(1)This paragraph explains what is meant by an asset related to shares in a company.
(2)An asset is related to shares in a company if it is—
(a)an option to acquire or dispose of shares or an interest in shares in that company, or
(b)a security to which are attached rights by virtue of which the holder is or may become entitled to acquire or dispose of (whether by conversion or exchange or otherwise)—
(i)shares or an interest in shares in that company, or
(ii)an option to acquire or dispose of shares or an interest in shares in that company, or
(iii)another security falling within this paragraph, or
(c)an option to acquire or dispose of any security within paragraph (b) or an interest in any such security, or
(d)an interest in, or option over, any such option or security as is mentioned in paragraph (a), (b) or (c), or
(e)any interest in, or option over, any such interest or option as is mentioned in paragraph (d) or this paragraph.
(3)In determining whether a security is within sub-paragraph (2)(b), no account shall be taken—
(a)of any rights attached to the security other than rights relating, directly or indirectly, to shares of the company in question, or
(b)of rights as regards which, at the time the security came into existence, there was no more than a negligible likelihood that they would in due course be exercised to a significant extent.
(4)The references in this paragraph to an interest in a security or option have a meaning corresponding to that given by paragraph 29 in relation to an interest in shares.
31In this Schedule the expressions listed below are defined or otherwise explained by the provisions indicated:
asset related to shares | paragraph 30 |
company | paragraph 26(1)(a) |
company invested in | paragraph 1 |
51% subsidiary | paragraph 26(4) and (5) |
group (and member of group) | paragraph 26(1)(b) and (5) |
holding company | paragraph 26(3) |
interest in shares | paragraph 29 |
investing company | paragraph 1 |
joint venture company | paragraph 24(1) |
qualifying shareholding (in joint venture company) | paragraph 24(2) |
subgroup | paragraph 26(2) |
trade | paragraph 27 |
trading company | paragraph 20 |
trading group | paragraph 21 |
trading subgroup | paragraph 22 |
twelve-month period | paragraph 28 |
Part 5Consequential provisions
32Any exemption conferred by this Schedule shall be disregarded in determining whether shares are “chargeable shares”, or an asset is a “chargeable asset”, for the purposes of any enactment relating to corporation tax or capital gains tax.
33(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)a company makes a claim under section 24(2) (assets of negligible value) in relation to shares held by it, and
(b)by virtue of this Schedule any loss accruing to the company on a disposal of the shares at the time of the claim would not be an allowable loss.
(2)Where this paragraph applies the company may not exercise the option under section 24(2) to specify a time earlier than the time of the claim as the time when the shares are treated as sold and reacquired by virtue of that subsection.
(3)This paragraph applies to—
(a)an interest in shares in a company, or
(b)an asset related to shares in a company,
as it applies to shares in that company.
34(1)The exemptions conferred by this Schedule do not apply to or affect a chargeable gain or allowable loss deemed to accrue on a disposal by virtue of section 116(10)(b) (reorganisations, conversions and reconstructions: deemed accrual of gain or loss held over on earlier transaction).
(2)Sub-paragraph (1) does not apply where the relevant earlier transaction was a deemed disposal and reacquisition under section 92(7) of the Finance Act 1996 (convertible securities etc).
35(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)a company disposes of an asset in circumstances falling within section 140(4) (recovery of charge postponed on transfer of assets to non-resident company), and
(b)by virtue of this Schedule any gain accruing to the company on the disposal would not be a chargeable gain.
(2)Where this paragraph applies the amount by which the consideration received on the disposal would be treated as increased by virtue of section 140(4) shall instead be treated as accruing to the company, at the time of the disposal, as a chargeable gain to which this Schedule does not apply.
(3)Any reference in section 140 to an amount being brought or taken into account under or in accordance with subsection (4) of that section includes a reference to an amount being treated, by virtue of sub-paragraph (2) above, as accruing as a chargeable gain.
36(1)Where—
(a)an asset acquired by a company otherwise than as trading stock of a trade carried on by it is appropriated by the company for the purposes of the trade as trading stock (whether on the commencement of the trade or otherwise), and
(b)if the company had then sold the asset for its market value, a chargeable gain or allowable loss would have accrued to the company but for an exemption conferred by this Schedule,
the company is treated for the purposes of the enactments relating to chargeable gains as if it had thereby disposed of the asset for its market value.
(2)Section 173 (transfers within a group: trading stock) applies in relation to this paragraph as it applies in relation to section 161 (appropriations to and from stock).
37(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)a company disposes of an asset,
(b)the expenditure allowable in computing a gain or loss on that disposal falls to be reduced because of a claim for relief under section 165 (gifts relief) in relation to an earlier disposal, and
(c)by virtue of this Schedule any gain accruing to the company on the disposal mentioned in paragraph (a) would not be a chargeable gain.
(2)Where this paragraph applies the amount of the held-over gain, or an appropriate proportion of it, shall be treated as accruing to the company, at the time of the disposal mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(a), as a chargeable gain to which this Schedule does not apply.
(3)An “appropriate proportion” means a proportion determined on a just and reasonable basis having regard to the subject matter of the disposal mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(a) and the subject matter of the earlier disposal that was the subject of the claim for relief under section 165.
(4)In this paragraph “held-over gain” has the same meaning as in section 165.
38(1)Where—
(a)a company, as a result of ceasing at any time (“the time of degrouping”) to be a member of a group, is treated by section 179(3) as having sold and immediately reacquired an asset, and
(b)if the company owning the asset at the time of degrouping had disposed of it immediately before that time, any gain accruing on the disposal would by virtue of this Schedule not have been a chargeable gain,
section 179(3) shall have effect as if it provided for the deemed sale and reacquisition to be treated as taking place immediately before the time of degrouping.
(2)Where—
(a)a company, as a result of ceasing at any time (“the relevant time”) to satisfy the conditions in section 179(7), is treated by section 179(6) as having sold and immediately reacquired an asset, and
(b)if the company owning the asset at the relevant time had disposed of it immediately before that time, any gain accruing on the disposal would by virtue of this Schedule not have been a chargeable gain,
section 179(6) shall have effect as if it provided for the deemed sale and reacquisition to be treated as taking place immediately before the relevant time.
(3)Any reference in this paragraph to a disposal or other event taking place immediately before the time of degrouping or the relevant time is to its taking place immediately before that time but on the same day.
39(1)No gain or loss shall be treated as arising under the FOREX matching regulations on a disposal on which by virtue of this Schedule any gain would not be a chargeable gain.
(2)The “FOREX matching regulations” means any regulations made under Schedule 15 to the Finance Act 1993 (exchange gains and losses: alternative method of calculation).”.
2In section 179(4) of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) (deemed sale and reacquisition on company ceasing to be member of group: time when chargeable gain or allowable loss treated as accruing), for “which, apart from this subsection, would accrue" substitute “ accruing ”.
3(1)Section 241 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (furnished holiday lettings) is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (3) (commercial letting of furnished holiday accommodation to be treated as trade for certain purposes), for the opening words substitute—
“Subject to subsections (4) to (8) below, for the purposes of the provisions mentioned in subsection (3A) below—”.
(3)After that subsection insert—
“(3A)The provisions referred to in subsection (3) above are—
sections 152 to 157 (roll-over relief on replacement of business asset),
section 165 (gifts relief),
Section 253 (relief for loans to traders),
Schedule A1 (taper relief),
Schedule 6 (retirement relief etc), and
Schedule 7AC (exemptions for disposals by companies with substantial shareholding).”.
(4)In subsection (4) for “sections mentioned in subsection (3)" substitute “ provisions mentioned in subsection (3A) ”.
4In Schedule 7B of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) (modification of Act in relation to overseas life insurance companies), after paragraph 15 add—
“16In Schedule 7AC, in paragraph 3(2)(c)(ii), the words “section 11(2)(b), (c) or (d) of the Taxes Act" shall be treated as substituted for the words “section 10(3)".”.
5In Schedule 15 to the Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) (the corporate venturing scheme), in paragraphs 84(1) and 85(1) after “(see paragraph 83" insert “ and paragraph 4 of Schedule 7AC to the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 ”.
Section 45
1For section 135 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (exchange of securities for those in another company) substitute—
(1)This section applies in the following circumstances where a company (“company B”) issues shares or debentures to a person in exchange for shares in or debentures of another company (“company A”).
(2)The circumstances are:
Case 1
Where company B holds, or in consequence of the exchange will hold, more than 25% of the ordinary share capital of company A.
Case 2
Where company B issues the shares or debentures in exchange for shares as the result of a general offer—
(a) made to members of company A or any class of them (with or without exceptions for persons connected with company B), and
(b) made in the first instance on a condition such that if it were satisfied company B would have control of company A.
Case 3
Where company B holds, or in consequence of the exchange will hold, the greater part of the voting power in company A.
(3)Where this section applies, sections 127 to 131 (share reorganisations etc) apply with the necessary adaptations as if company A and company B were the same company and the exchange were a reorganisation of its share capital.
(4)In this section “ordinary share capital” has the meaning given by section 832(1) of the Taxes Act and also includes—
(a)in relation to a unit trust scheme, any rights that are treated by section 99(1)(b) of this Act (application of Act to unit trust schemes) as shares in a company, and
(b)in relation to a company that has no share capital, any interests in the company possessed by members of the company.
(5)This section applies in relation to a company that has no share capital as if references to shares in or debentures of the company included any interests in the company possessed by members of the company.
(6)This section has effect subject to section 137(1) (exchange must be for bona fide commercial reasons and not part of tax avoidance scheme).”.
2For section 136 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) (reconstruction or amalgamation involving issue of securities) substitute—
(1)This section applies where—
(a)an arrangement between a company (“company A”) and—
(i)the persons holding shares in or debentures of the company, or
(ii)where there are different classes of shares in or debentures of the company, the persons holding any class of those shares or debentures,
is entered into for the purposes of, or in connection with, a scheme of reconstruction, and
(b)under the arrangement—
(i)another company (“company B”) issues shares or debentures to those persons in respect of and in proportion to (or as nearly as may be in proportion to) their relevant holdings in company A, and
(ii)the shares in or debentures of company A comprised in relevant holdings are retained by those persons or are cancelled or otherwise extinguished.
(2)Where this section applies—
(a)those persons are treated as exchanging their relevant holdings in company A for the shares or debentures held by them in consequence of the arrangement, and
(b)sections 127 to 131 (share reorganisations etc) apply with the necessary adaptations as if company A and company B were the same company and the exchange were a reorganisation of its share capital.
For this purpose shares in or debentures of company A comprised in relevant holdings that are retained are treated as if they had been cancelled and replaced by a new issue.
(3)Where a reorganisation of the share capital of company A is carried out for the purposes of the scheme of reconstruction, the provisions of subsections (1) and (2) apply in relation to the position after the reorganisation.
(4)In this section—
(a)“scheme of reconstruction” has the meaning given by Schedule 5AA to this Act;
(b)references to “relevant holdings” of shares in or debentures of company A are—
(i)where there is only one class of shares in or debentures of the company, to holdings of shares in or debentures of the company, and
(ii)where there are different classes of shares in or debentures of the company, to holdings of a class of shares or debentures that is involved in the scheme of reconstruction (within the meaning of paragraph 2 of Schedule 5AA);
(c)references to shares or debentures being retained include their being retained with altered rights or in an altered form, whether as the result of reduction, consolidation, division or otherwise; and
(d)any reference to a reorganisation of a company’s share capital is to a reorganisation within the meaning of section 126.
(5)This section applies in relation to a company that has no share capital as if references to shares in or debentures of the company included any interests in the company possessed by members of the company.
(6)This section has effect subject to section 137(1) (scheme of reconstruction must be for bona fide commercial reasons and not part of tax avoidance scheme).”.
3After Schedule 5A to the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 insert—
Meaning of “scheme of reconstruction"
1In section 136 “scheme of reconstruction” means a scheme of merger, division or other restructuring that meets the first and second, and either the third or the fourth, of the following conditions.
2The first condition is that the scheme involves the issue of ordinary share capital of a company (“the successor company”) or of more than one company (“the successor companies”)—
(a)to holders of ordinary share capital of another company (“the original company”) or, where there are different classes of ordinary share capital of that company, to holders of one or more classes of ordinary share capital of that company (the classes “involved in the scheme of reconstruction”), or
(b)to holders of ordinary share capital of more than one other company (“the original companies”) or, where there are different classes of ordinary share capital of one or more of the original company or companies, to holders of ordinary share capital of any of those companies or of one or more classes of ordinary share capital of any of those companies (the classes “involved in the scheme of reconstruction”),
and does not involve the issue of ordinary share capital of the successor company, or (as the case may be) any of the successor companies, to anyone else.
3(1)The second condition is that under the scheme the entitlement of any person to acquire ordinary share capital of the successor company or companies by virtue of holding relevant shares, or relevant shares of any class, is the same as that of any other person holding such shares or shares of that class.
(2)For this purpose “relevant shares” means shares comprised—
(a)where there is one original company, in the ordinary share capital of that company or, as the case may be, in the ordinary share capital of that company of a class involved in the scheme of reconstruction;
(b)where there is more than one original company, in the ordinary share capital of any of those companies or, as the case may be, in the ordinary share capital of any of those companies of a class involved in the scheme of reconstruction.
4(1)The third condition is that the effect of the restructuring is—
(a)where there is one original company, that the business or substantially the whole of the business carried on by the company is carried on—
(i)by a successor company which is not the original company, or
(ii)by two or more successor companies (which may include the original company);
(b)where there is more than one original company, that all or part of the business or businesses carried on by one or more of the original companies is carried on by a different company, and the whole or substantially the whole of the businesses carried on by the original companies are carried on—
(i)where there is one successor company, by that company (which may be one of the original companies), or
(ii)where there are two or more successor companies, by those companies (which may be the same as the original companies or include any of those companies).
(2)The reference in sub-paragraph (1)(a)(ii) or (b)(ii) to the whole or substantially the whole of a business, or businesses, being carried on by two or more companies includes the case where the activities of those companies taken together embrace the whole or substantially the whole of the business, or businesses, in question.
(3)For the purposes of this paragraph a business carried on by a company that is under the control of another company is treated as carried on by the controlling company as well as by the controlled company.
Section 840 of the Taxes Act (meaning of “control") applies for the purposes of this sub-paragraph.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph the holding and management of assets that are retained by the original company, or any of the original companies, for the purpose of making a capital distribution in respect of shares in the company shall be disregarded.
In this sub-paragraph “capital distribution” has the same meaning as in section 122.
5The fourth condition is that—
(a)the scheme is carried out in pursuance of a compromise or arrangement—
(i)under section 425 of the Companies Act 1985 or Article 418 of the Companies (Northern Ireland) Order 1986, or
(ii)under any corresponding provision of the law of a country or territory outside the United Kingdom, and
(b)no part of the business of the original company, or of any of the original companies, is transferred under the scheme to any other person.
6Where a reorganisation of the share capital of the original company, or of any of the original companies, is carried out for the purposes of the scheme of reconstruction, the provisions of the first and second conditions apply in relation to the position after the reorganisation.
7An issue of shares in or debentures of the successor company, or any of the successor companies, after the latest date on which any ordinary share capital of the successor company, or any of them, is issued—
(a)in consideration of the transfer of any business, or part of a business, under the scheme, or
(b)in pursuance of the compromise or arrangement mentioned in paragraph 5(a),
shall be disregarded for the purposes of the first and second conditions.
8(1)In this Schedule “ordinary share capital” has the meaning given by section 832(1) of the Taxes Act and also includes—
(a)in relation to a unit trust scheme, any rights that are treated by section 99(1)(b) of this Act (application of Act to unit trust schemes) as shares in a company, and
(b)in relation to a company that has no share capital, any interests in the company possessed by members of the company.
(2)Any reference in this Schedule to a reorganisation of a company’s share capital is to a reorganisation within the meaning of section 126.”.
4(1)The Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.
(2)In section 299 (disposal of shares)—
F4(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(b)in subsection (4C), as that section applies to shares issued before 1st January 1994 (business expansion scheme),
for “(whether or not by virtue of section 135(3) of that Act)" substitute “ (including a case where that section applies by virtue of any enactment relating to chargeable gains) ”, and for the words from “shall be construed" to the end substitute “ have the same meaning as in section 127 of the 1992 Act (or, as the case may be, that section as applied by virtue of the enactment concerned) ”.
F5(3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F6(4). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(5)In section 757 (disposal of material interests in non-qualifying offshore funds), for subsections (5) and (6) substitute—
“(5)Section 135 of the 1992 Act (exchange of securities for those in another company treated as not involving a disposal) does not apply for the purposes of this Chapter if the company that is company A for the purposes of that section is or was at a material time a non-qualifying offshore fund and the company that is company B for those purposes is not such a fund.
In a case where that section would apply apart from this subsection, the exchange in question (of shares, debentures or other interests in or of an entity that is or was at a material time a non-qualifying offshore fund) shall for the purposes of this Chapter constitute a disposal of interests in the offshore fund for a consideration equal to their market value at the time of the exchange.
(6)Section 136 of the 1992 Act (scheme of reconstruction involving issue of securities treated as exchange not involving disposal) does not apply for the purposes of this Chapter so as to require persons to be treated as exchanging shares, debentures or other interests in or of an entity that is or was at a material time a non-qualifying offshore fund for assets that do not constitute interests in such a fund.
In a case where that section would apply apart from this subsection, the deemed exchange in question (of shares, debentures or other interests in or of an entity that is or was at a material time a non-qualifying offshore fund) shall for the purposes of this Chapter constitute a disposal of interests in the offshore fund for a consideration equal to their market value at the time of the deemed exchange.”.
(6)In section 758(6) (offshore funds operating equalisation arrangements: events treated as disposal), for the words from “section 135" to the end substitute “ any provision of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of that Act ”.
(7)In section 842 (investment trusts), at the end of subsection (4) add “and “scheme of reconstruction” has the same meaning as in section 136 of that Act".
Textual Amendments
F4Sch. 9 para. 4(2)(a) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 2 (with Sch. 2)
F5Sch. 9 para. 4(3) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 2 (with Sch. 2)
F6Sch. 9 para. 4(4) repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
5(1)The Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) is amended as follows.
(2)In section 31 (distributions within a group followed by a disposal of shares), for subsection (6)(b) substitute—
“(b)an exchange, or deemed exchange, of shares in or debentures of a company held by company A for shares in or debentures of another company, being a company associated with company A immediately after the transaction, that is treated by virtue of section 135 or 136 as a reorganisation of share capital within the meaning of section 126 to which sections 127 to 131 apply with the necessary adaptations, or”.
(3)In section 34 (transactions treated as a reorganisation of capital)—
(a)in subsections (1)(a), (1A), (1B) and (1C)(a) for “sections 127 and 135(3)" substitute “ section 135 or 136 ”;
(b)in the closing words of subsection (1) for “section 135(3)" substitute “ section 135 or 136 ”; and
(c)in subsection (2) for the words from the beginning to “and in those subsections" substitute “ In subsections (1) to (1C) ” (the words omitted being unnecessary).
(4)In section 102 (collective investment schemes with property divided into separate parts), in subsection (3)(b) after “135" insert “ or 136 ”.
(5)In section 137 (restriction on application of sections 135 and 136)—
(a)in subsection (1), for “, reconstruction or amalgamation" substitute “ or scheme of reconstruction ”; and
(b)in subsection (6), for “section 136(3)" substitute “ section 135(5), 136(5) ”.
(6)In section 138(1) (procedure for clearance in advance), for “, reconstruction or amalgamation" substitute “ or scheme of reconstruction ”.
(7)In section 139 (reconstruction involving transfer of business), for subsection (9) substitute—
“(9)In this section “scheme of reconstruction” has the same meaning as in section 136.”.
(8)In section 147 (quoted options treated as part of new holdings)—
(a)in subsection (1) for “or amalgamation" substitute “ , exchange or scheme of reconstruction ”; and
(b)in subsection (2) at the end insert “ and “scheme of reconstruction" has the same meaning as in section 136 ”.
(9)In section 151B (venture capital trusts: supplementary), in subsection (8) for paragraph (c) substitute—
“(c)a reference to the exchanged holding is, in relation to section 135 or 136, to the shares in the company referred to in that section as company A.”.
(10)In section 171(3) (transfers within a group) for “by virtue of sections 127 and 135" substitute “ by section 127 as it applies by virtue of section 135 ”.
F7(11). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(12)In section 251 (debts: general provisions)—
(a)in subsection (2) for “132 and 135" substitute “ 132, 135 and 136 ”;
(b)in subsection (3)—
(i)for “132 and 135" substitute “ 132, 135 and 136 ”, and
(ii)for “either section 132 or 135" substitute “ section 132, 135 or 136 ”;
(c)in subsection (6)(b) for the words from “unaffected" to the end substitute “ to which section 135 applies and which is unaffected by section 137(1) ”.
F8(13). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(14)In Schedule 6 (retirement relief: supplementary provisions), in paragraph 2(2) for “section 135(3)" substitute “ section 135 or 136 ”.
Textual Amendments
F7Sch. 9 para. 5(11) repealed (19.7.2007) by Finance Act 2007 (c. 11), Sch. 27 Pt. 2(9)
F8Sch. 9 para. 5(13) omitted (with effect in accordance with Sch. 2 para. 56(3) of the amending Act) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 2 para. 55(e)(ii)
6(1)Schedule 15 to the Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) (corporate venturing scheme) is amended as follows.
(2)In paragraph 71 (tax avoidance), in sub-paragraph (1)(b)(ii) for “reconstructions and amalgamations" substitute “ schemes of reconstruction ”.
(3)In paragraph 82(1) (company reconstructions and amalgamations), in the closing words for “company reconstructions and amalgamations" substitute “ share exchanges and company reconstructions ”.
(4)In paragraph 93(7) (identification of shares on a disposal: cases to which section 127 applies)—
(a)for “(whether or not by virtue of section 135(3) of that Act)" substitute “ (including a case where that section applies by virtue of any enactment relating to chargeable gains) ”; and
(b)for the words from “shall be construed" to the end substitute “ have the same meaning as in section 127 of the 1992 Act (or, as the case may be, that section as applied by virtue of the enactment concerned) ”.
(5)In paragraph 96 (meaning of “disposal")—
(a)in sub-paragraph (2)(a) for “section 136(1)" substitute “ section 136 ”;
(b)in sub-paragraph (2)(b) for “sections 135 and 136 of that Act to bona fide reconstructions and amalgamations" substitute “ section 136 of that Act to bona fide schemes of reconstruction ”.
7(1)Subject to paragraph 8, the provisions of this Schedule have effect in relation to shares or debentures issued on or after 17th April 2002 (“the commencement date”).
(2)The reference in sub-paragraph (1) to shares or debentures includes any interests falling to be treated as shares or debentures for the purposes of section 135 or 136 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) as substituted by this Schedule.
8(1)Paragraph 4(2), (3) and (5) and paragraph 6(2), (4) and (5) have effect in relation to disposals on or after the commencement date.
F9(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)Paragraph 4(6) has effect in relation to events occurring on or after the commencement date.
(4)Paragraph 4(7) has effect in relation to shares and securities (within the meaning of section 842 of the Taxes Act 1988) issued on or after the commencement date.
Textual Amendments
F9Sch. 9 para. 8(2) repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 47
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F10Sch. 10 omitted (with effect in accordance with Sch. 2 para. 56(3) of the amending Act) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 2 para. 55(e)(iii)
Section 51
1The Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) is amended in accordance with paragraphs 2 to 6.
2(1)Section 2 (persons and gains chargeable to capital gains tax, and allowable losses) is amended as follows.
F11(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(3)In paragraph (b) of that subsection, omit “77, 86,".
(4)After that subsection insert—
“(6)Allowable losses must (notwithstanding section 2A(6)) be deducted under paragraph (a)(i) of subsection (5) above before any may be deducted under paragraph (aa)(i) of that subsection.
(7)Where in any year of assessment—
(a)there are amounts treated as accruing to a person by virtue of section 77 or 86,
(b)two or more of those amounts, or elements of them—
(i)relate to different settlements, and
(ii)attract taper relief (by virtue of subsection (5)(aa)(ii) above) at the same rate, or are not eligible for taper relief, and
(c)losses are deductible from the amounts or elements mentioned in paragraph (b) above (“the equal-tapered amounts”) but are not enough to exhaust them all,
the deduction applicable to each of the equal-tapered amounts shall be the appropriate proportion of the aggregate of those losses.
The “appropriate proportion” is that given by dividing the equal-tapered amount in question by the total of the equal-tapered amounts.
(8)The references to section 86 in subsection (5)(aa) above (in the opening words) and subsection (7)(a) above include references to that section read with section 10A.”.
Textual Amendments
F11Sch. 11 para. 2(2) omitted (with effect in accordance with Sch. 2 para. 56(3) of the amending Act) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 2 para. 55(e)(iv)
F123. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F12Sch. 11 para. 3 omitted (with effect in accordance with Sch. 2 para. 22 of the amending Act) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 2 para. 21(f)
F134. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F13Sch. 11 paras. 4-6 omitted (with effect in accordance with Sch. 2 para. 56(3) of the amending Act) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 2 para. 55(e)(iv)
F135. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F13Sch. 11 paras. 4-6 omitted (with effect in accordance with Sch. 2 para. 56(3) of the amending Act) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 2 para. 55(e)(iv)
F136. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F13Sch. 11 paras. 4-6 omitted (with effect in accordance with Sch. 2 para. 56(3) of the amending Act) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 2 para. 55(e)(iv)
7This Schedule applies in relation to chargeable gains treated as accruing to a person by virtue of section 77 or 86 (read, where appropriate, with section 10A) of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) in the year 2003-04 and subsequent years of assessment.
8(1)This Schedule also applies, if the person so elects, in relation to chargeable gains so accruing to a person in any of the years of assessment 2000-01, 2001-02 and 2002-03.
(2)An election under this paragraph—
(a)must be made by a notice given to an officer of the Board no later than 31st January 2005;
(b)where chargeable gains are treated as accruing in respect of two or more settlements, may be restricted to those treated as accruing in respect of the settlement or settlements specified in the election.
(3)All such adjustments shall be made, whether by way of discharge or repayment of tax, the making of assessments or otherwise, as are required to give effect to an election under this paragraph.
(4)Where—
(a)a person makes an election under this paragraph for any one or more of the years of assessment 2000-01, 2001-02 and 2002-03, and
(b)the effect of the election, or (as the case may be) both or all of them taken together, is to increase the total amount of tax that the person is entitled to recover from the trustees of a particular settlement for those three years under section 78(1)(a) of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 or paragraph 6 of Schedule 5 to that Act,
the trustees of that settlement must join in the election, or (as the case may be) each of them that has that effect or contributes to it.
Section 53
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F14Sch. 12 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 536, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 54
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F15Sch. 13 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 537, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 54
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F16Sch. 14 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 56
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F17Sch. 15 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 57
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C1Sch. 16 modified by 2005 c. 7, s. 54A (as inserted (10.7.2008) by The Alternative Finance Arrangements (Community Investment Tax Relief) Order 2008 (S.I. 2008/1821), arts. 1, 2)
1(1)[F18A company] (“the investor”) that makes an investment (“the investment”) in a body is eligible for relief in respect of the investment if—
(a)that body is accredited as a community development finance institution under this Schedule at the time the investment is made (see Part 2);
(b)the investment is a qualifying investment (see Part 3); and
(c)the general conditions of Part 4 are satisfied.
(2)In this Schedule references to “the CDFI” are to the body in which the investment is made.
Textual Amendments
F18Words in Sch. 16 para. 1(1) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(2) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I24Sch. 16 para. 1 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
2(1)For the purposes of this Schedule, a [F19company] makes an investment in a body at any time when—
(a)[F19it] makes a loan (whether secured or unsecured) to the body, or
(b)an issue of securities of or shares in the body, for which [F19it] has subscribed, is made to [F19it].
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(a)—
(a)a [F20company] does not make a loan to a body where—
(i)the body uses overdraft facilities provided by that [F20company], or
(ii)that [F20company] subscribes for or otherwise acquires securities of the body;
(b)where the loan agreement authorises the body to draw down amounts of the loan over a period of time, the loan is treated as made at the time when the first amount is drawn down.
Textual Amendments
F19Words in Sch. 16 para. 2(1) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(3)(a) (with Sch. 2)
F20Word in Sch. 16 para. 2(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(3)(b) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I25Sch. 16 para. 2 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
3In this Schedule “the five year period” means the period of five years beginning with the day the investment is made (“the investment date”).
Commencement Information
I26Sch. 16 para. 3 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
Textual Amendments
F21 Sch. 16 para. 4 and cross-heading substituted for Sch. 16 paras. 4-7 (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(4) (with Sch. 2)
4(1)Chapter 2 of Part 7 of ITA 2007 applies for the purposes of this Schedule as it applies for the purposes of that Part.U.K.
(2)Chapter 2 of Part 7 of that Act makes provision with respect to—
(a)applications and criteria for accreditation as community development finance institutions (see section 340),
(b)the terms and conditions of accreditation (see section 341),
(c)the period of accreditation (see section 342), and
(d)the delegation of the Secretary of State’s functions under that Chapter (see section 343).
(3)In this Schedule “accreditation period” has the meaning given by section 342(1) of ITA 2007.]
8For the purposes of this Schedule the investment is a “qualifying investment” in the CDFI if—
(a)the investment consists of—
(i)a loan in relation to which the conditions of paragraph 9 are satisfied,
(ii)securities in relation to which the conditions of paragraph 10 are satisfied, or
(iii)shares in relation to which the conditions of paragraph 11 are satisfied;
(b)the investor receives from the CDFI a valid tax relief certificate in relation to the investment (see paragraph 12); and
(c)the requirements of paragraph 13 are met in relation to pre-arranged protection against risks.
Commencement Information
I27Sch. 16 para. 8 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
9(1)The first condition of this paragraph is that either—
(a)the CDFI receives from the investor, on the investment date, the full amount of the loan, or
(b)if the loan agreement authorises the CDFI to draw down amounts of the loan over a period of time, the end of that period is not later than 18 months after the investment date.
(2)The second condition is that the loan must not carry any present or future right to be converted into or exchanged for a loan which is, or securities, shares, or other rights which are, redeemable within the five year period.
(3)The third condition is that the loan must not have been made on terms that allow any person to require—
(a)the repayment during the first two years of the five year period of any of the loan capital advanced in those two years,
(b)the repayment during the third year of that period of more than 25% of the loan capital outstanding at the end of those two years,
(c)the repayment before the end of the fourth year of that period of more than 50% of that loan capital, or
(d)the repayment before the end of that period of more than 75% of that loan capital.
(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (3), any requirement arising as a consequence of a failure of the CDFI to fulfil any obligation of the loan agreement shall be disregarded if that obligation—
(a)is imposed by reason only of the commercial risks to which the investor is exposed as lender under that agreement, and
(b)is no more likely to be breached than any obligation that might reasonably have been agreed in respect of the loan in the absence of this Schedule.
(5)The Treasury may by order substitute for any percentage for the time being specified in sub-paragraph (3) such other percentage as they think fit; and any such substitution shall have effect in relation to loans made by a [F22company] on or after such date as may be specified in the order.
Textual Amendments
F22Word in Sch. 16 para. 9(5) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(5) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I28Sch. 16 para. 9 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
10(1)The first condition of this paragraph is that the securities must be—
(a)subscribed for wholly in cash, and
(b)fully paid for on the investment date.
(2)The second condition is that the securities must not carry—
(a)any present or future right to be redeemed within the five year period, or
(b)any present or future right to be converted into or exchanged for a loan which is, or securities, shares or other rights which are, redeemable within that period.
Commencement Information
I29Sch. 16 para. 10 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
11(1)The first condition of this paragraph is that the shares must be—
(a)subscribed for wholly in cash, and
(b)fully paid up on the investment date.
Shares are not fully paid up for the purposes of paragraph (b) if there is any undertaking to pay cash to the CDFI at a future date in connection with the acquisition of the shares.
(2)The second condition is that the shares must not carry—
(a)any present or future right to be redeemed during the five year period, or
(b)any present or future right to be converted into or exchanged for a loan which is, or securities, shares or other rights which are, redeemable within that period.
Commencement Information
I30Sch. 16 para. 11 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
12(1)For the purposes of this Schedule a “tax relief certificate” means a certificate issued by the CDFI in respect of the investment, which is in such form as the Board may specify.
[F23(2)The CDFI must not issue tax relief certificates in respect of investments made in the CDFI in an accreditation period if the aggregate value of—
(a)those investments, and
(b)any investments to which sub-paragraph (2A) applies,
will exceed the limit for that period.
(2A)This sub-paragraph applies to investments which—
(a)have been made in the CDFI in the accreditation period, and
(b)in respect of which the CDFI has issued tax relief certificates under section 348 of ITA 2007 (which makes in relation to income tax provision corresponding to that made by this paragraph).
(2B)The limit for an accreditation period is—
(a)£10 million if the CDFI is accredited for the period as a retail community development finance institution (see section 340(8) of ITA 2007 as applied by paragraph 4), and
(b)£20 million in any other case.]
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) the value of an investment made in the CDFI is—
(a)if the investment consists of a loan—
(i)the amount of the loan, or
(ii)where the loan agreement authorises the CDFI to draw down amounts of the loan over a period of time, the amount committed under the loan agreement; and
(b)if the investment consists of securities or shares, the amount subscribed for them.
(4)The Treasury may, by order, substitute for any amount for the time being specified in sub-paragraph [F24(2B)] such other amount as they think fit.
(5)Any such substitution shall have effect in relation to such accreditation periods as may be specified in the order; and those periods may, if the substitution increases the amount for the time being specified in sub-paragraph [F25(2B)], include periods beginning before the order takes effect.
(6)Any tax relief certificate issued wholly or partly in contravention of sub-paragraph (2) is invalid.
(7)A body is liable to a penalty not exceeding £3000 if it issues a tax relief certificate which is made fraudulently or negligently.
Textual Amendments
F23Sch. 16 para. 12(2)-(2B) substituted for Sch. 16 para. 12(2) (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(6) (with Sch. 2)
F24Word in Sch. 16 para. 12(4) substituted (with effect in accordance with art. 1(2) of the amending S.I.) by The Income Tax Act 2007 (Amendment) (No. 2) Order 2007 (S.I. 2007/1820), arts. 1(1), 3
F25Word in Sch. 16 para. 12(5) substituted (with effect in accordance with art. 1(2) of the amending S.I.) by The Income Tax Act 2007 (Amendment) (No. 2) Order 2007 (S.I. 2007/1820), arts. 1(1), 3
Commencement Information
I31Sch. 16 para. 12 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
13(1)Any arrangements—
(a)under which the investment is made, or
(b)made, before the investor makes the investment, in relation to or in connection with the making of the investment,
must not include arrangements (“excluded arrangements”) the main purpose of which, or one of the main purposes of which, is (by means of any insurance, indemnity or guarantee or otherwise) to provide partial or complete protection for the investor against what would otherwise be the risks attached to making the investment.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1), excluded arrangements do not include any arrangements which are confined to the provision for the investor of any such protection against those risks as might reasonably be expected to be provided for commercial reasons if the investment were made in the course of a business of banking.
(3)For the purposes of this paragraph “arrangements” includes any scheme, agreement or understanding, whether or not legally enforceable.
Commencement Information
I32Sch. 16 para. 13 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
14(1)The investor must not control the CDFI at any time during the five year period.
(2)In this paragraph references to the investor include any person connected with the investor.
(3)Where the CDFI is a body corporate, the question whether the investor controls the CDFI shall, for the purposes of this paragraph, be determined in accordance with section 840 of the Taxes Act 1988.
This is subject to sub-paragraph (6).
(4)In any other case, the investor shall be treated, for those purposes, as having control of the CDFI if [F26it] has power to secure—
(a)by means of the possession of voting power in the CDFI, or
(b)by virtue of any powers conferred by the constitution of, or any other document regulating, the CDFI,
that the affairs of the body are conducted in accordance with [F26its] wishes.
This is subject to sub-paragraphs (5) and (6).
(5)Where the CDFI is a partnership and the investor is a member of that partnership, for the purposes of determining in accordance with this paragraph whether the investor controls the CDFI the other members of that partnership shall not, by virtue of their membership of the CDFI, be treated as partners of the investor.
(6)In determining whether the investor controls the CDFI there shall be attributed to the investor (to the extent that it would not otherwise be the case)—
(a)any rights or powers that the investor is entitled to acquire at a future date or will, at a future date, become entitled to acquire, and
(b)any rights or powers which another person holds on behalf of the investor or may be required to exercise, by direction, on [F27its] behalf.
Textual Amendments
F26Words in Sch. 16 para. 14(4) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(7)(a) (with Sch. 2)
F27Word in Sch. 16 para. 14(6) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(7)(b) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I33Sch. 16 para. 14 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
15(1)The investor must be the sole beneficial owner of the investment when it is made.
(2)Where the investment consists of a loan, the person beneficially entitled to repayment of the loan shall be treated as the beneficial owner of the loan for the purposes of this Schedule.
Commencement Information
I34Sch. 16 para. 15 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
16The investor must not be accredited as a community development finance institution under this Schedule (see Part 2) on the investment date.
Commencement Information
I35Sch. 16 para. 16 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
17(1)Where the CDFI is a partnership, the investment must not consist of or include any amount of capital contributed by the investor on becoming a member of the partnership.
(2)For this purpose, the amount of capital contributed by the investor on becoming a member of the partnership includes any amount which—
(a)purports to be provided by the investor by way of loan capital, and
(b)is accounted for as partners’ capital in the accounts of the partnership.
Commencement Information
I36Sch. 16 para. 17 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
18The investment must not be made as part of a scheme or arrangement the main purpose of which, or one of the main purposes of which, is the avoidance of tax.
Commencement Information
I37Sch. 16 para. 18 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
F2819. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F28Sch. 16 para. 19 repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(8), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
20(1)This paragraph applies where the investor is—
F29(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(b)eligible for relief in respect of the investment (see paragraph 1(1)).
(2)Where the investor makes a claim for a relevant accounting period in respect of a loan, securities or shares in accordance with this Part, the amount of its liability for corporation tax for that period shall be reduced by the smaller of—
(a)5% of the invested amount in respect of that loan or those securities or shares for the period, and
(b)the amount which reduces the investor’s liability to zero.
(3)For this purpose the “relevant” accounting periods are—
(a)the accounting period in which the investment date falls, and
(b)each of the accounting periods in which the subsequent four anniversaries of that date fall.
(4)The investor is entitled to make a claim for relief for a relevant accounting period if—
(a)it appears to the investor that the conditions for the relief are for the time being satisfied, and
(b)it has received a tax relief certificate (see paragraph 12) relating to the investment from the CDFI,
but no claim may be made before the end of the accounting period to which it relates.
(5)Sub-paragraph (4) is subject to the following provisions—
(a)paragraph 22 (loans: no claim after disposal or excessive repayments or receipts of value);
(b)paragraph 23 (securities or shares: no claim after disposal or excessive receipts of value);
(c)paragraph 24 (loss of accreditation by CDFI);
(d)paragraph 25 (accreditation of the investor).
Textual Amendments
F29Sch. 16 para. 20(1)(a) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(9), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I38Sch. 16 para. 20 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
21(1)This paragraph applies for the purpose of determining “the invested amount” in respect of any loan, securities or shares comprised in the investment.
This is subject to paragraphs 31(2) and 38 (which adjust “the invested amount” in certain cases where value is received).
(2)In the case of a loan, the invested amount is—
(a)for the F30... accounting period in which the investment date falls, the average capital balance for the first year of the five year period;
(b)for the F30... accounting period in which the first anniversary of the investment date falls, the average capital balance for the second year of the five year period;
(c)for any subsequent F30... accounting period—
(i)the average capital balance for the period of one year beginning with the anniversary of the investment date falling in the F30... accounting period concerned, or
(ii)if less, the average capital balance for the period of six months beginning eighteen months after the investment date.
(3)In the case of securities or shares, the invested amount for [F31an] accounting period is the amount subscribed by the investor for the securities or shares.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph, the average capital balance of the loan for a period is the mean of the daily balances of capital outstanding during the period.
Textual Amendments
F30Words in Sch. 16 para. 21(2) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(10)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F31Word in Sch. 16 para. 21(3) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(10)(b) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I39Sch. 16 para. 21 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
22(1)Where the investment consists of a loan, no claim may be made in respect of [F32an] accounting period if—
(a)the investor disposes of the whole or any part of the loan before the qualifying date relating to [F33that period],
(b)at any time after the investment is made but before that qualifying date, the amount of the capital outstanding on the loan is reduced to nil, or
(c)before that qualifying date, paragraphs (a) and (b) of paragraph 30(1) (repayments of loan in five year period exceeding permitted limits) apply in relation to the investment (whether by virtue of paragraph 31 (receipts of value treated as repayments) or otherwise).
For the purposes of paragraph (a) any repayment of the loan is to be disregarded.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph the qualifying date relating to [F34an] accounting period is the anniversary of the investment date next occurring after the end of [F35that period].
Textual Amendments
F32Word in Sch. 16 para. 22(1) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(11) (with Sch. 2)
F33Words in Sch. 16 para. 22(1) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(11) (with Sch. 2)
F34Word in Sch. 16 para. 22(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(11) (with Sch. 2)
F35Words in Sch. 16 para. 22(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(11) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I40Sch. 16 para. 22 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
23(1)Where the investment consists of securities or shares, a claim made in respect of [F36an] accounting period must relate only to those securities or shares held by the investor, as sole beneficial owner, continuously throughout the period—
(a)beginning when the investment is made, and
(b)ending immediately before the qualifying date relating to the F37... accounting period.
(2)No claim for relief may be made in relation to [F38an] accounting period if before the qualifying date relating to [F39that period] paragraphs (a) to (d) of paragraph 32(1) (receipts of value in five year period exceeding permitted limits) apply in relation to the investment or any part of it.
(3)For the purposes of this paragraph, the qualifying date relating to [F40an] accounting period is the anniversary of the investment date next occurring after the end of [F41that period].
Textual Amendments
F36Word in Sch. 16 para. 23(1) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(12)(a) (with Sch. 2)
F37Words in Sch. 16 para. 23(1)(b) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(12)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F38Word in Sch. 16 para. 23(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(12)(b) (with Sch. 2)
F39Words in Sch. 16 para. 23(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(12)(b) (with Sch. 2)
F40Word in Sch. 16 para. 23(3) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(12)(c) (with Sch. 2)
F41Words in Sch. 16 para. 23(3) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(12)(c) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I41Sch. 16 para. 23 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
24(1)Where the CDFI ceases to be accredited under Part 2 with effect from a time (“the relevant time”) within the five year period, no claim for relief relating to the investment may be made by the investor—
(a)for the relevant F42... accounting period, or
(b)for any later F42... accounting period.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) the relevant F43... accounting period is—
(a)where the relevant time falls within the first year of the five year period, the F43... accounting period in which the investment date fell, and
(b)in any other case, the F44... period in which fell the last anniversary of that date before the relevant time (or, if the relevant time itself falls on an anniversary of the investment date, the F44... period in which that anniversary falls).
Textual Amendments
F42Words in Sch. 16 para. 24(1) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(13)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F43Words in Sch. 16 para. 24(2) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(13)(b)(i), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F44Words in Sch. 16 para. 24(2)(b) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(13)(b)(ii), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I42Sch. 16 para. 24 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
25(1)Where the investor F45... becomes accredited with effect from a time (“the relevant time”) within the five year period, no claim for relief relating to the investment may be made by the investor for the relevant accounting period or any later period.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) the relevant accounting period is—
(a)where the relevant time falls within the first year of the five year period, the accounting period in which the investment date fell, and
(b)in any other case, the period in which fell the last anniversary of that date before the relevant time (or, if the relevant time itself falls on an anniversary of the investment date, the period in which that anniversary falls).
Textual Amendments
F45Words in Sch. 16 para. 25(1) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(14), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I43Sch. 16 para. 25 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
26(1)In this Schedule—
F46(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(b)references to the relief attributable to any loan, securities or shares in respect of an accounting period shall be read as references to the reduction made in the investor’s liability to corporation tax for that period that is attributed to that loan, or those securities or shares, in accordance with this paragraph.
This is subject to the provisions of Part 6 for the withdrawal or reduction of relief.
(2)Where the investor’s liability to F47... corporation tax is reduced for [F48an] accounting period under this Part, then—
(a)where the reduction is obtained by reason of one loan, or securities or shares comprised in one issue, the amount of the tax reduction shall be attributed to that loan or those securities or shares, and
(b)where the reduction is obtained by reason of a loan or loans, securities or shares comprised in two or more investments, the reduction—
(i)shall be apportioned between the loan or loans, securities or shares in each of those investments in the same proportions as the invested amounts in respect of the loan or loans, securities or shares for the F49... period, and
(ii)shall be attributed to that loan or those loans, securities or shares accordingly.
(3)Where under this paragraph an amount of any reduction of F50... corporation tax is attributed to any securities in the same issue, a proportionate part of that amount shall be attributed to each security.
(4)Where under this paragraph an amount of any reduction of F51... corporation tax is attributed to any shares in the same issue, a proportionate part of that amount shall be attributed to each of those shares.
(5)If corresponding bonus shares are issued to the investor in respect of any shares (“ ”) comprised in the investment that have been continuously held by the investor, as sole beneficial owner, from the time they were issued until the issue of the bonus shares—
(a)a proportionate part of any amount attributed to the original shares, in respect of [F52an] accounting period, immediately before the bonus shares are issued shall be attributed to each of the shares in the holding comprising the original shares and the bonus shares, in respect of [F53that period], and
(b)after the issue of the bonus shares, this Schedule shall apply as if—
(i)the original issue had included the bonus shares, and
(ii)the bonus shares had been held by the investor, as sole beneficial owner, continuously from the time the original shares were issued until the bonus shares were issued.
(6)In sub-paragraph (5)—
“
” means bonus shares that are in the same company, of the same class, and carry the same rights as the original shares; and“original issue” means the issue of shares forming the investment.
(7)If relief attributable to a loan or any securities or shares falls to be withdrawn under Part 6, the relief attributable to that loan or each of those securities or shares shall be reduced to nil.
(8)If relief attributable to any securities or shares falls to be reduced under that Part by any amount, the relief attributable to each of those securities or shares shall be reduced by a proportionate part of that amount.
Textual Amendments
F46Sch. 16 para. 26(1)(a) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(15)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F47Words in Sch. 16 para. 26(2) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(15)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F48Word in Sch. 16 para. 26(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(15)(b) (with Sch. 2)
F49Words in Sch. 16 para. 26(2)(b)(i) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(15)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F50Words in Sch. 16 para. 26(3) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(15)(c), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F51Words in Sch. 16 para. 26(4) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(15)(c), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F52Word in Sch. 16 para. 26(5) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(15)(d) (with Sch. 2)
F53Words in Sch. 16 para. 26(5) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(15)(d) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I44Sch. 16 para. 26 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
27(1)This paragraph applies where any relief has been obtained which—
(a)is subsequently found not to have been due, or
(b)falls to be withdrawn or reduced under this Part.
F54(2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F54(3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(4)F55... the relief shall be withdrawn or reduced by making an assessment to corporation tax F56... for the accounting period for which the relief was obtained.
Textual Amendments
F54Sch. 16 para. 27(2)(3) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(16)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F55Words in Sch. 16 para. 27(4) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(16)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F56Words in Sch. 16 para. 27(4) repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 538, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Commencement Information
I45Sch. 16 para. 27 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
28(1)Where the investment consists of a loan, if within the five year period—
(a)the investor disposes of the whole of the investment, otherwise than by way of a permitted disposal, or
(b)the investor disposes of a part of the investment,
any relief attributable to the investment in respect of any F57... accounting period must be withdrawn.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph—
(a)a disposal is “permitted” if—
(i)it is by way of a distribution in the course of dissolving or winding up the CDFI,
(ii)it is a disposal within section 24(1) of the 1992 Act (entire loss, destruction, dissipation or extinction of asset),
(iii)it is a deemed disposal under section 24(2) of that Act (claim that value of asset has become negligible), or
(iv)it is made after the CDFI has ceased to be accredited under this Schedule, and
(b)a full or partial repayment of the loan shall not be treated as giving rise to a disposal.
Textual Amendments
F57Words in Sch. 16 para. 28(1) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(17), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I46Sch. 16 para. 28 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
29(1)This paragraph applies where the investment consists of securities or shares and—
(a)the investor disposes of the whole or any part of the investment (“the former investment”) within the five year period,
(b)the CDFI has not ceased to be accredited before the disposal, and
(c)the disposal does not arise by virtue of an event within paragraph 35(1)(a) (repayment, redemption or repurchase of securities or shares included in the investment).
(2)If the disposal is not a qualifying disposal, any relief attributable to the former investment in respect of any F58... accounting period must be withdrawn.
(3)If the disposal is a qualifying disposal, any relief attributable to the former investment for [F59an] accounting period must—
(a)if it is greater than an amount equal to 5% of the amount or value of the consideration (if any) which the investor receives for the former investment, be reduced by that amount, and
(b)in any other case, be withdrawn.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph “qualifying disposal” means a disposal that is—
(a)by way of a bargain made at arm’s length for full consideration, or
(b)a permitted disposal (within the meaning of paragraph 28).
(5)Where for any F60... accounting period—
(a)the amount of relief attributable to the former investment (“A”) is less than
(b)the amount (“B”) which is equal to 5% of the invested amount in respect of the former investment for [F61that period],
sub-paragraph (3)(a) shall have effect in relation to [F61that period] as if the amount or value referred to in that sub-paragraph were reduced by multiplying it by the fraction—
(6)Where the amount of relief attributable to the former investment in respect of [F62an] accounting period has been reduced before the relief was obtained, the amount of relief attributable to that investment shall be deemed for the purposes of sub-paragraph (5) to be the amount of the relief that would have been attributable had no such reduction been made before the relief was obtained.
(7)Sub-paragraph (6) does not apply to a reduction by virtue of paragraph 26(5) (attribution of relief where there is a corresponding issue of bonus shares).
Textual Amendments
F58Words in Sch. 16 para. 29(2) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(18)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F59Word in Sch. 16 para. 29(3) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(18)(b) (with Sch. 2)
F60Words in Sch. 16 para. 29(5) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(18)(c), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F61Words in Sch. 16 para. 29(5) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(18)(c) (with Sch. 2)
F62Word in Sch. 16 para. 29(6) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(18)(d) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I47Sch. 16 para. 29 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
30(1)Where the investment consists of a loan, if—
(a)the average capital balance of the loan for the third, fourth or final year of the five year period is less than the permitted balance for the year in question, and
(b)the difference between those balances is not an amount of insignificant value,
any relief attributable to the investment in respect of any F63... accounting period must be withdrawn.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph—
“the average capital balance” of the loan for a period is the mean of the daily balances of capital outstanding during that period, disregarding any non-standard repayments of the loan made in that period or at any earlier time;
“the permitted balance” of the loan is—
for the third year of the five year period, 75% of the average capital balance for the period of six months beginning 18 months after the investment date,
for the fourth year of that period, 50% of that balance, and
for the final year of that period, 25% of that balance.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2), a repayment of the loan is a non-standard repayment if it is made—
(a)at the choice or discretion of the CDFI and not as a direct or indirect consequence of any obligation provided for under the terms of the loan agreement, or
(b)as a consequence of the failure of the CDFI to fulfil any obligation of the loan agreement which—
(i)is imposed by reason only of the commercial risks to which the investor is exposed as lender under that agreement, and
(ii)is no more likely to be breached than any obligation that might reasonably have been agreed in respect of the loan in the absence of this Schedule.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph “an amount of insignificant value” means an amount which—
(a)does not exceed £1,000, or
(b)if it exceeds that amount, is insignificant in relation to the average capital balance of the loan for the year of the five year period in question.
Textual Amendments
F63Words in Sch. 16 para. 30(1) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(19), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I48Sch. 16 para. 30 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
31(1)This paragraph applies where the investment consists of a loan and the investor receives any value (other than insignificant value) from the CDFI during the period of restriction.
(2)The investor shall be treated for the purposes of—
(a)paragraph 21 (determination of “invested amount"), and
(b)paragraph 30 (repayments of loan capital),
as having received a repayment of the loan of an amount equal to the amount of the value received.
(3)For those purposes the repayment shall be treated as made—
(a)where the value was received in the first or second year of the period of restriction, at the beginning of that second year, and
(b)where the value was received in a later year of that period, at the beginning of the year in question.
(4)For the purposes of paragraph 30 the repayment shall be treated as a repayment other than a non-standard repayment (within the meaning of that paragraph).
(5)For the purposes of this paragraph the investor receives insignificant value where [F64the investor] receives an amount of insignificant value; and for this purpose “an amount of insignificant value” means an amount which—
(a)does not exceed £1,000, or
(b)if it exceeds that amount, is insignificant in relation to the average capital balance of the loan for the year of the period of restriction in which the value is received.
(6)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (5)(b)—
(a)“the average capital balance” of the loan for a year is the mean of the daily balances of capital outstanding during the year (disregarding the receipt of value in question), and
(b)any value received in the first year of the period of restriction shall be treated as received at the beginning of the second year of that period.
(7)This paragraph is subject to paragraph 37 (value received where there is more than one investment).
(8)Value received shall be disregarded, for the purposes of this paragraph, to the extent to which relief attributable to any loan, securities or shares in respect of any one or more F65... accounting periods has already been reduced or withdrawn on its account.
Textual Amendments
F64Words in Sch. 16 para. 31(5) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(20) (with Sch. 2)
F65Words in Sch. 16 para. 31(8) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(21), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I49Sch. 16 para. 31 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
32(1)Where the investment consists of securities or shares and—
(a)the investor receives any value (other than insignificant value) from the CDFI during the period of restriction,
(b)the investment or a part of it is held by the investor at the time the value is received and has been held by [F66the investor], as sole beneficial owner, continuously since the investment was made (“the continuing investment”),
(c)the receipt is wholly or partly in excess of the permitted level of receipts in respect of the continuing investment, and
(d)the amount of that excess (“the excess”) is not an amount of insignificant value,
any relief attributable to the continuing investment in respect of any F67... accounting period must be withdrawn.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) the permitted level of receipts is exceeded where—
(a)any amount of value is received by the investor (disregarding any amounts of insignificant value) in the first three years of the period of restriction, or
(b)the aggregate amount of value received by the investor (disregarding any amounts of insignificant value)—
(i)before the beginning of the fifth year of that period, exceeds 25% of the invested capital;
(ii)before the beginning of the final year of that period, exceeds 50% of the invested capital;
(iii)before the end of that period, exceeds 75% of the invested capital.
(3)In this paragraph—
“the invested capital”, in relation to the continuing investment, means the amount subscribed for the securities or shares concerned;
“an amount of insignificant value” means an amount of value which—
does not exceed £1,000, or
if it exceeds that amount, is insignificant in relation to the amount subscribed by the investor for the securities or shares comprising the continuing investment;
and for the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) the investor receives insignificant value where [F68the investor] receives an amount of insignificant value.
(4)This paragraph is subject to paragraph 37 (value received where there is more than one investment).
(5)Value received shall be disregarded, for the purposes of this paragraph, to the extent to which relief attributable to any loan, securities or shares in respect of any one or more F69... accounting periods has already been reduced or withdrawn on its account.
Textual Amendments
F66Words in Sch. 16 para. 32(1)(b) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(20) (with Sch. 2)
F67Words in Sch. 16 para. 32(1) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(22)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F68Words in Sch. 16 para. 32(3) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(20) (with Sch. 2)
F69Words in Sch. 16 para. 32(5) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(22)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I50Sch. 16 para. 32 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
33In this Part “the period of restriction” in relation to the investment is the period of six years beginning one year before the investment date.
Commencement Information
I51Sch. 16 para. 33 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
34(1)Where—
(a)value is received (“the relevant receipt”) by the investor from the CDFI at any time during the period of restriction relating to the investment,
(b)the investor has received from the CDFI one or more receipts of insignificant value at a time or times during that period but not later than the time of the relevant receipt, and
(c)the aggregate amount of the value of the receipts within paragraphs (a) and (b) is not an amount of insignificant value,
the investor shall be treated for the purposes of this Schedule as if the relevant receipt had been a receipt of an amount of value equal to that aggregate amount.
For this purpose a receipt does not fall within paragraph (b) if the whole or any part of it has previously been aggregated under this sub-paragraph.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph “an amount of insignificant value” means an amount of value which—
(a)does not exceed £1,000, or
(b)if it exceeds that amount, is insignificant in relation to the relevant amount.
(3)Where the investment consists of a loan, the relevant amount for the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) is—
(a)if the relevant receipt is received in the first or second year of the period of restriction, the average capital balance of the loan for the second year of that period, and
(b)if the relevant receipt is received in a later year, the average capital balance of the loan for the year in question.
(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (3)—
(a)the average capital balance of the loan for a year is the mean of the daily balances of capital outstanding during the year, and
(b)the relevant receipt and any receipts within sub-paragraph (1)(b) shall be disregarded when calculating the average capital balance for the year in question.
(5)Where the investment consists of securities or shares, the relevant amount for the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) is—
(a)if the relevant receipt is received in the first year of the period of restriction, the amount subscribed for the securities or shares, and
(b)in any other case, the amount subscribed for such of the securities or shares as—
(i)are held by the investor at the time the relevant receipt is received, and
(ii)have been held by [F70the investor], as sole beneficial owner, continuously since the investment was made.
Textual Amendments
F70Words in Sch. 16 para. 34(5)(b)(ii) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(20) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I52Sch. 16 para. 34 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
35(1)For the purposes of this Part the investor receives value from the CDFI at any time when the CDFI—
(a)repays, redeems or repurchases any securities or shares included in the investment;
(b)releases or waives any liability of the investor to the CDFI or discharges, or undertakes to discharge, any liability of the investor to a third person;
(c)makes a loan or advance to the investor which has not been repaid in full before the investment is made;
(d)provides a benefit or facility for—
(i)the investor or any associates of the investor, or
(ii)F71..., directors or employees of the investor or any of their associates;
(e)disposes of an asset to the investor for no consideration or for a consideration which is or the value of which is less than the market value of the asset;
(f)acquires an asset from the investor for a consideration which is or the value of which is more than the market value of the asset; or
(g)makes a payment to the investor other than a qualifying payment.
[F72(1A)But if the investor is a bank, the investor does not receive value from the CDFI when the CDFI makes a deposit with the investor in the course of its ordinary banking arrangements.]
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(b) the CDFI shall be treated as having released or waived a liability if the liability is not discharged within 12 months of the time when it ought to have been discharged.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1)(c) there shall be treated as if it were a loan made by the CDFI to the investor—
(a)the amount of any debt incurred by the investor to the CDFI (other than an ordinary trade debt), and
(b)the amount of any debt due from the investor to a third person which has been assigned to the CDFI.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph—
(a)references to a debt or liability do not, in relation to a person, include references to any debt or liability which would be discharged by the making by that person of a qualifying payment;
(b)references to a benefit or facility do not include references to any benefit or facility provided in circumstances such that, if a payment had been made of an amount equal to its value, that payment would have been a qualifying payment; and
(c)any reference to a payment or disposal to a person includes a reference to a payment or disposal made to that person indirectly or to his order or for his benefit.
In paragraphs (a) to (c) references to “a person” include references to any person who, at any time in the period of restriction in question, is connected with that person, whether or not he is so connected at the material time.
(5)In this paragraph—
[F73“bank” has the meaning given by section 840A of the Taxes Act 1988;]
“qualifying payment” means—
any payment by any person for any goods, services or facilities provided by the investor (in the course of [F74the investor's] trade or otherwise) which is reasonable in relation to the market value of those goods, services or facilities;
the payment by any person of any interest which represents no more than a reasonable commercial return on money lent to that person;
the payment by any company of any dividend or other distribution which does not exceed a normal return on any investment in shares in or securities of that company;
any payment for the acquisition of an asset which does not exceed its market value;
the payment by any person, as rent for any property occupied by the person, of an amount not exceeding a reasonable and commercial rent for the property; and
a payment in discharge of an ordinary trade debt; and
“ordinary trade debt” means any debt for goods or services supplied in the ordinary course of a trade or business where any credit given—
does not exceed six months, and
is not longer than that normally given to customers of the person carrying on the trade or business.
Textual Amendments
F71Words in Sch. 16 para. 35(1)(d)(ii) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(23), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F72Sch. 16 para. 35(1A) inserted (retrospectively) by Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), s. 54(2)(4)
F73Words in Sch. 16 para. 35(5) inserted (retrospectively) by Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), s. 54(3)(4)
F74Words in Sch. 16 para. 35(5) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(24) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I53Sch. 16 para. 35 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
36For the purposes of this Part the amount of the value received is—
(a)in a case within paragraph 35(1)(a), the amount received by the investor;
(b)in a case within paragraph 35(1)(b), the amount of the liability;
(c)in a case within paragraph 35(1)(c)—
(i)the amount of the loan or advance, less
(ii)the amount of any repayment made before the investment is made;
(d)in a case within paragraph 35(1)(d)—
(i)the cost to the CDFI of providing the benefit or facility, less
(ii)any consideration given for it by the investor or any associate of [F75the investor];
(e)in a case within paragraph 35(1)(e) or (f), the difference between the market value of the asset and the consideration (if any) received for it; and
(f)in a case within paragraph 35(1)(g), the amount of the payment.
Textual Amendments
F75Words in Sch. 16 para. 36(d)(ii) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(25) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I54Sch. 16 para. 36 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
37(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)the investor makes two or more investments in the CDFI (being investments in relation to which the investor is eligible for and claims relief), and
(b)the investor receives value (other than value within paragraph 35(1)(a)) which falls within the periods of restriction relating to two or more of those investments.
(2)Where this paragraph applies, paragraphs 31, 32, 34 and 38 have effect in relation to each investment referred to in sub-paragraph (1)(b) as if the amount of the value received were reduced by multiplying it by the fraction—
(3)For this purpose—
(a)A is the appropriate amount in respect of the investment in question, and
(b)B is the aggregate of that amount and the appropriate amount or amounts in respect of the other investment or investments.
(4)Where the investment consists of a loan, the appropriate amount for the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) is—
(a)if the value is received in the first or second year of the period of restriction, the average capital balance of the loan for the second year of that period, and
(b)if the value is received in a later year, the average capital balance of the loan for the year in question.
(5)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (4)—
(a)the average capital balance of the loan for a year is the mean of the daily balances of capital outstanding during the year, and
(b)the receipt of value shall be disregarded when calculating the average capital balance for the year in question.
(6)Where the investment consists of securities or shares, the appropriate amount for the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) is—
(a)if the value is received in the first year of the period of restriction, the amount subscribed for the securities or shares, and
(b)in any other case, the amount subscribed for such of the securities or shares as—
(i)are held by the investor at the time the value is received, and
(ii)have been held by [F76the investor], as sole beneficial owner, continuously since the investment was made.
Textual Amendments
F76Words in Sch. 16 para. 37(6) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(26) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I55Sch. 16 para. 37 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
38(1)This paragraph applies where the investment consists of securities or shares and—
(a)the investor receives any value (other than insignificant value) from the CDFI during the period of restriction, and
(b)the investment or a part of it is held by the investor at the time the value is received and has been held by [F77the investor], as sole beneficial owner, continuously since the investment was made (“the continuing investment”),
but no relief attributable to the continuing investment is withdrawn under paragraph 32 as a result of the receipt.
(2)For the purposes of calculating any relief in respect of any securities or shares included in the continuing investment for any relevant F78... accounting period, the amount subscribed for the securities or shares comprising the continuing investment shall be treated as reduced by the amount of the value received.
(3)For this purpose the “relevant” F79... accounting periods are—
(a)any F79... accounting period ending on or after the anniversary of the investment date immediately preceding the receipt of value, or
(b)if the value was received on an anniversary of the investment date, any F79... accounting period ending on or after that anniversary.
(4)For the purposes of this paragraph the investor receives insignificant value where [F80the investor] receives an amount of insignificant value; and for these purposes “an amount of insignificant value” means an amount of value which—
(a)does not exceed £1,000, or
(b)if it exceeds that amount, is insignificant in relation to the amount subscribed by the investor for the securities or shares comprising the continuing investment.
Textual Amendments
F77Words in Sch. 16 para. 38(1) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(27)(a) (with Sch. 2)
F78Words in Sch. 16 para. 38(2) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(27)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F79Words in Sch. 16 para. 38(3) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(27)(c), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F80Words in Sch. 16 para. 38(4) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(27)(d) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I56Sch. 16 para. 38 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
39In paragraphs 31 to 38 references to the investor or the CDFI include references to any person who at any time in the period of restriction relating to the investment is connected with the investor or, as the case may be, CDFI, whether or not he is connected at the material time.
Commencement Information
I57Sch. 16 para. 39 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
F8140. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F81Sch. 16 para. 40 repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(28), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F8241. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F82Sch. 16 para. 41 repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(28), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
42(1)Where—
(a)the investor has obtained relief in respect of the investment, and
(b)an event occurs by reason of which relief attributable to the investment for any F83... accounting period falls to be withdrawn or reduced by virtue of paragraph 28, 29, 30 or 32,
the investor must give the Inland Revenue a notice containing particulars of the event.
(2)Where sub-paragraph (1) requires the giving of a notice, then, subject to sub-paragraph (3) the investor must give the notice not later than—
F84(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(b)F85... the end of the period of 12 months beginning with the end of the accounting period in which the event occurred.
(3)Where—
(a)the investor is required to give a notice by virtue of the receipt of value by a person connected with the investor (see paragraph 39), and
(b)the end of the period of 60 days beginning when the investor comes to know of that event is later than the final notice date under sub-paragraph (2),
the notice must be given within that 60 day period.
(4)In this paragraph “the Inland Revenue” means any officer of the Board.
Textual Amendments
F83Words in Sch. 16 para. 42(1) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(29)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F84Sch. 16 para. 42(2)(a) and word repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(29)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F85Words in Sch. 16 para. 42(2)(b) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(29)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I58Sch. 16 para. 42 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
43(1)No obligation as to secrecy or other restriction on the disclosure of information imposed by statute or otherwise prevents the disclosure of information—
(a)by the Secretary of State to the Inland Revenue for the purpose of assisting the Inland Revenue to discharge their functions under the [F86Corporation Tax Acts] so far as relating to matters arising under this Schedule, or
(b)by the Inland Revenue to the Secretary of State for the purpose of assisting the Secretary of State to discharge his functions under this Schedule.
(2)Information obtained by such disclosure shall not be further disclosed except for the purposes of legal proceedings arising out of the functions referred to.
(3)In this paragraph “the Inland Revenue” means any officer of the Board.
Textual Amendments
F86Words in Sch. 16 para. 43(1) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(30) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I59Sch. 16 para. 43 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
44(1)For the purposes of this Schedule—
(a)loans made by or to, or disposed of by, a nominee for a person shall be treated as made by or to, or disposed of by, that person;
(b)securities or shares subscribed for by, issued to, acquired or held by or disposed of by a nominee for a person shall be treated as subscribed for by, issued to, acquired or held by or disposed of by that person.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) references to things done by or to a nominee for a person include things done by or to a bare trustee for a person.
Commencement Information
I60Sch. 16 para. 44 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
45No application shall be made under section 55(3) or (4) of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) (application for postponement of payment of tax pending appeal) on the ground that a [F87company] is eligible for relief unless a claim for the relief has been duly made by the [F87company] under Part 5 of this Schedule.
Textual Amendments
F87Word in Sch. 16 para. 45 substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(31) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I61Sch. 16 para. 45 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
46(1)In this Schedule—
(a)references (however expressed) to an issue of securities of any body are to such securities of that body as carry the same rights and are issued under the same terms and on the same day, and
(b)references (however expressed) to an issue of shares in any body are to such shares in that body as are of the same class and issued on the same day.
(2)In this Schedule references (however expressed) to an issue of securities of or shares in a body to a [F88company] are references to such of the securities or shares in an issue of securities of or shares in that body as are issued to that [F88company] in one capacity.
Textual Amendments
F88Word in Sch. 16 para. 46(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(32) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I62Sch. 16 para. 46 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
47(1)In any case where—
(a)the investor disposes of part of a holding of securities or shares (“the holding”), and
(b)the holding includes securities or shares to which relief is attributable in respect of one or more F89... accounting periods that have been held continuously by the investor from the time they were issued until the disposal,
this paragraph applies for the purpose of identifying the securities or shares disposed of.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph “holding” means—
(a)any number of securities of a company carrying the same rights and issued under the same terms held by the investor in the same capacity, growing or diminishing as securities carrying those rights and issued under those terms are acquired or disposed of, or
(b)any number of shares in a company of the same class held by the investor in the same capacity, growing or diminishing as shares of that class are acquired or disposed of.
(3)Where securities or shares included in the holding have been acquired by the investor on different days, then, for the purposes F90... of this Schedule, any disposal by the investor of any of those securities or shares shall be treated as relating to those acquired on an earlier day rather than to those acquired on a later day.
(4)Where securities or shares included in the holding have been acquired by the investor on the same day, then, for the purposes F91... of this Schedule, if there is a disposal by the investor of any of those securities or shares, any securities or shares—
(a)to which relief is attributable, and
(b)which have been held by the investor continuously from the time they were issued until the time of disposal,
shall be treated as disposed of after any other securities or shares included in the holding which were acquired by the investor on that day.
F92(5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F92(6). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(7)In a case to which section 127 of [F93the 1992 Act] (equation of original shares and new holding) applies, shares comprised in the new holding shall be treated for the purposes of sub-paragraphs (3) and (4) as acquired when the original shares were acquired.
(8)In sub-paragraph (7)—
(a)the reference to section 127 includes a reference to that section as it is applied by virtue of any enactment relating to chargeable gains, and
(b)“new holding” have the same meaning as in section 127 or (as the case may be) that section as applied by virtue of the enactment in question. ” and “
Textual Amendments
F89Words in Sch. 16 para. 47(1) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(33)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F90Words in Sch. 16 para. 47(3) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(33)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F91Words in Sch. 16 para. 47(4) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(33)(b), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F92Sch. 16 para. 47(5)(6) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(33)(c), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F93Words in Sch. 16 para. 47(7) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(33)(d) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I63Sch. 16 para. 47 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
48(1)Subject to sub-paragraph (2), in this Schedule “disposal” shall be construed in accordance with the 1992 Act, and cognate expressions shall be construed accordingly.
(2)An investor shall be treated for the purposes of this ScheduleF94... as disposing of any securities or shares which but for [F95section 151BC(1) of the 1992 Act the investor] —
(a)would be treated as exchanging for other securities or shares by virtue of section 136 of the 1992 Act, or
(b)would be so treated but for section 137(1) of the 1992 Act (which restricts section 136 of that Act to bona fide reconstructions).
Textual Amendments
F94Words in Sch. 16 para. 48(2) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(34)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F95Words in Sch. 16 para. 48(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(34)(b) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I64Sch. 16 para. 48 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
49(1)This paragraph applies where for the purposes of this Schedule it falls to be determined whether the investor has held the investment (or any part of it) continuously throughout any period.
(2)The investor shall not be treated as having held the investment (or any part of it) continuously throughout a period if—
(a)[F96the investor] is deemed, under any provision of the 1992 Act, to have disposed of and immediately reacquired the investment (or part) at any time during the period, or
(b)[F96the investor] is treated as having disposed of the investment (or part) at any such time, by virtue of paragraph 48(2).
Textual Amendments
F96Words in Sch. 16 para. 49(2) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(35) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I65Sch. 16 para. 49 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
50(1)In this Schedule “associate”, in relation to a person, means—
(a)any relative or partner of that person,
(b)the trustee or trustees of any settlement in relation to which that person, or any relative of his (living or dead), is or was a settlor, and
(c)where that person is interested in any shares or obligations of a company which are subject to any trust or are part of the estate of a deceased person—
(i)the trustee or trustees of the settlement concerned or, as the case may be, the personal representatives of the deceased, and
(ii)if that person is a company, any other company interested in those shares or obligations.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1)(a) and (b) “relative” means [F97spouse or civil partner], parent or remoter forebear or child or remoter issue.
(3)In sub-paragraph (1)(b) “settlor” and “settlement” have the same meaning as in [F98Chapter 5 of Part 5 of the Income Tax (Trading and Other Income) Act 2005 (see section 620 of that Act)].
Textual Amendments
F97Words in Sch. 16 para. 50(2) substituted (5.12.2005) by The Tax and Civil Partnership Regulations 2005 (S.I. 2005/3229), regs. 1(1), 135
F98Words in Sch. 16 para. 50(3) substituted (6.4.2005) by Income Tax (Trading and Other Income) Act 2005 (c. 5), s. 883(1), Sch. 1 para. 577(3) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I66Sch. 16 para. 50 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
51(1)In this Schedule—
“the Board” means the Commissioners of Inland Revenue;
“body” includes an unincorporated association;
“relief” means relief under Part 5 of this Schedule;
F99. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
“the 1992 Act” means the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12).
(2)For the purposes of this Schedule shares in a company shall not be treated as being of the same class unless they would be so treated if dealt with on the Stock Exchange.
(3)Section 839 of the Taxes Act 1988 (connected persons) applies for the purposes of this Schedule.
(4)For the purposes of this Schedule the market value at any time of any asset is the price which it might reasonably be expected to fetch on a sale at that time in the open market free from any interest or right which exists by way of security in or over it.
(5)In this Schedule—
(a)references to relief obtained by the investor in respect of any investment (or part of an investment) include references to relief obtained by the investor in respect of that investment (or part) at any time after the investor has disposed of it, and
(b)references to the withdrawal or reduction of relief obtained by the investor in respect of the investment (or any part of it) include references to the withdrawal or reduction of relief obtained in respect of that investment (or part) at any such time.
(6)In the case of any condition that cannot be satisfied until a future date—
(a)references in this Schedule to a condition being satisfied for the time being are to nothing having occurred to prevent its being satisfied, and
(b)references to its continuing to be satisfied are to nothing occurring to prevent its being satisfied.
Textual Amendments
F99Words in Sch. 16 para. 51(1) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(36), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I67Sch. 16 para. 51 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
52In this Schedule the following expressions are defined or otherwise explained by the provisions indicated:
[F100Accreditation period | paragraph 4(3)] |
associate | paragraph 50 |
the Board | paragraph 51(1) |
body | paragraph 51(1) |
the CDFI | paragraph 1(2) |
disposal | paragraph 48 |
the five year period | paragraph 3 |
held continuously (in relation to securities or shares) | paragraph 49 |
the invested amount | paragraph 21 |
the investment | paragraph 1 |
the investment date | paragraph 3 |
the investor | paragraph 1 |
issue of securities or shares | paragraph 46 |
owner (in relation to a loan) | paragraph 15(2) |
the 1992 Act | paragraph 51(1) |
period of restriction | paragraph 33 |
relief | paragraph 51(1) |
tax relief certificate | paragraph 12 |
Textual Amendments
F100Words in Sch. 16 para. 52 inserted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 419(37) (with Sch. 2)
Commencement Information
I68Sch. 16 para. 52 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, arts. 2, 3
Section 57
Commencement Information
I69Sch. 17 in force at 23.1.2003 by S.I. 2003/88, art. 2
1U.K.In section 98 of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9), in the second column of the Table, after the final entry insert—
“paragraph 42 of Schedule 16 to the Finance Act 2002
. ”
F1012U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F101Sch. 17 para. 2 repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 2 (with Sch. 2)
F1023U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F102Sch. 17 para. 3 repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F1034U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F103Sch. 17 para. 4 repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
5U.K.In Schedule 18 to the Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) (company tax returns, assessments and related matters), in paragraph 8 (calculation of tax payable), after paragraph 1A of the second step of the calculation in sub-paragraph (1) insert—
“1BAny relief under Part 5 of Schedule 16 to the Finance Act 2002 (community investment tax relief).”.
Section 58
1A club is entitled to be registered as a community amateur sports club if it is, and is required by its constitution to be, a club that—
(a)is open to the whole community,
(b)is organised on an amateur basis, and
(c)has as its main purpose the provision of facilities for, and promotion of participation in, one or more eligible sports.
In this Schedule “registered club” means a club that is so registered.
2(1)A club is open to the whole community if—
(a)membership of the club is open to all without discrimination,
(b)the facilities of the club are available to members without discrimination, and
(c)any fees are set at a level that does not pose a significant obstacle to membership or use of the club’s facilities.
(2)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (1) “discrimination” includes indirect discrimination and includes, in particular—
(a)discrimination on grounds of ethnicity, nationality, sexual orientation, religion or beliefs;
(b)discrimination on grounds of sex, age or disability, except as a necessary consequence of the requirements of a particular sport.
(3)This paragraph does not prevent a club from having different classes of membership depending on—
(a)the age of the member;
(b)whether the member is a student;
(c)whether the member is waged or unwaged;
(d)whether the member is a playing or a non-playing member;
(e)how far from the club the member lives;
(f)any restriction on the days or times when the member has access to the club’s facilities.
3(1)A club is organised on an amateur basis if—
(a)it is non-profit making,
(b)it provides for members and their guests only the ordinary benefits of an amateur sports club, and
(c)its constitution provides for any net assets on the dissolution of the club to be applied for approved sporting or charitable purposes.
(2)A club is “non-profit making” if its constitution requires any surplus income or gains to be reinvested in the club and does not permit any distribution of club assets, in cash or in kind, to members or third parties.
This does not prevent donations by the club to charities or to other clubs that are registered as community amateur sports clubs.
(3)The ordinary benefits of an amateur sports club are—
(a)provision of sporting facilities;
(b)reasonable provision and maintenance of club-owned sports equipment;
(c)provision of suitably qualified coaches;
(d)provision, or reimbursement of the costs, of coaching courses;
(e)provision of insurance cover;
(f)provision of medical treatment;
(g)reimbursement of reasonable travel expenses incurred by players and officials travelling to away matches;
(h)reasonable provision of post-match refreshments for players and match officials;
(i)sale or supply of food or drink as a social adjunct to the sporting purposes of the club.
(4)Sub-paragraph (3) does not prevent a club from—
(a)entering into an agreement with a member for the supply to the club of goods or services, or
(b)employing and paying remuneration to staff who are also members of the club,
provided the terms are approved by the governing body of the club without the member concerned being present and are agreed with the member on an arm’s length basis.
(5)In relation to the application of the net assets on the dissolution of the club, “approved sporting or charitable purposes” means such of the following as may be approved by the members of the club in general meeting or by the members of the governing body of the club—
(a)the purposes of the governing body of an eligible sport for the purposes of which the club existed, for use in related community sport;
(b)the purposes of another club that is registered as a community amateur sports club;
(c)the purposes of a charity.
4(1)Where—
(a)a club is a registered club throughout an accounting period,
(b)its trading income for that period (before deduction of any expenses) does not exceed [F104£30,000],
(c)the whole of that income is applied for qualifying purposes, and
(d)the club makes a claim under this paragraph to the Inland Revenue,
it shall be exempt from corporation tax on that income.
(2)In relation to an accounting period that is shorter than 12 months, sub-paragraph (1)(b) has effect as if the amount specified there were proportionately reduced.
(3)Where a club is a registered club for only part of an accounting period, sub-paragraph (1) has effect as if—
(a)that part were a separate accounting period;
(b)the club’s trading income for that part were the proportionately reduced amount of its trading income for the actual accounting period.
(4)In this paragraph “trading income” means [F105profits that (apart from this paragraph) are chargeable under Chapter 2 of Part 3 of CTA 2009 and are—
(a)means profits of a trade carried on wholly or partly in the United Kingdom, or
(b)profits of an activity other than a trade.]
Textual Amendments
F104Word in Sch. 18 para. 4(1)(b) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 56(4)(5) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), s. 56(2)
F105Words in Sch. 18 para. 4(4) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 539(2) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
5(1)Where—
(a)a club is a registered club throughout an accounting period,
(b)the whole of its interest income and gift aid income for that period is applied for qualifying purposes, and
(c)the club makes a claim under this paragraph to the Inland Revenue,
it shall be exempt from corporation tax on that income.
(2)Where a club is a registered club for only part of an accounting period, sub-paragraph (1) has effect as if—
(a)that part were a separate accounting period;
(b)the club’s interest income for that part were the proportionately reduced amount of its interest income for the actual accounting period.
(3)In this paragraph—
(a)“interest income”, in relation to a club, means interest [F106which (apart from this paragraph) would be required to be brought into account under Part 5 of the Corporation Tax Act 2009 (loan relationships) as a non-trading credit of the club;]
(b)“gift aid income”, in relation to a club, means gifts to the club that are treated as annual payments by section 25(10) of the Finance Act 1990 (c. 29) (gift aid) F107....
[F108(4)For the purposes of this paragraph, section 25(10) of the Finance Act 1990 (gift aid) has effect as if a registered club were a charitable company.]
Textual Amendments
F106Words in Sch. 18 para. 5(3)(a) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 539(3) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F107Words in Sch. 18 para. 5(3)(b) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 420(2)(a), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
F108Sch. 18 para. 5(4) inserted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 420(2)(b) (with Sch. 2)
6(1)Where—
(a)a club is a registered club throughout an accounting period,
(b)its property income for that period (before deduction of any expenses) does not exceed [F109£20,000],
(c)the whole of that income is applied for qualifying purposes, and
(d)the club makes a claim under this paragraph to the Inland Revenue,
it shall be exempt from corporation tax on that income.
(2)In relation to an accounting period that is shorter than 12 months, sub-paragraph (1)(b) has effect as if the amount specified there were proportionately reduced.
(3)Where a club is a registered club for only part of an accounting period, sub-paragraph (1) has effect as if—
(a)that part were a separate accounting period;
(b)the club’s property income for that part were the proportionately reduced amount of its property income for the actual accounting period.
(4)In this paragraph “property income” means income that (apart from this paragraph) is chargeable to tax under Schedule A.
Textual Amendments
F109Word in Sch. 18 para. 6(1)(b) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 56(4)(5) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), s. 56(3)
7A gain accruing to a registered club shall not be a chargeable gain if—
(a)the whole of the gain is applied for qualifying purposes, and
(b)the club makes a claim under this paragraph to the Inland Revenue.
8(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)any of a club’s income or gains for an accounting period are exempted from tax under this Part (or would be so exempted but for this paragraph), and
(b)in that accounting period the club incurs expenditure for non-qualifying purposes.
(2)In this paragraph—
A is the total amount of income and gains mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(a);
N is the amount of the expenditure mentioned in sub-paragraph (1)(b);
T is the aggregate of—
(a) the club’s income (whether taxable or not, and before deduction of any expenses) for the accounting period, and
(b) the club’s gains that are chargeable gains, together with those that would be chargeable but for paragraph 7, for that period.
(3)Where N is less than T, the total amount of income and gains for the accounting period exempted under this Part is reduced to—
(4)Where N is equal to T, the total amount of income and gains for the accounting period exempted under this Part is reduced to nil.
(5)Where N is greater than T—
(a)the total amount of income and gains for the accounting period exempted under this Part is reduced to nil, and
(b)the surplus amount is carried back to previous accounting periods (taking later ones before earlier ones) and deducted from the amounts exempted under this Part for those periods, until it is exhausted.
In paragraph (b) “the surplus amount” means—
(6)The reference in paragraph (b) of sub-paragraph (5) to previous accounting periods is to accounting periods ending not more than six years before the end of the accounting period mentioned in paragraph (a) of that sub-paragraph.
(7)To the extent that an amount exempted under this Part has been reduced under sub-paragraph (3), (4) or (5) in respect of expenditure incurred for non-qualifying purposes in a particular accounting period, it may not be reduced again under sub-paragraph (5) in respect of expenditure so incurred in a later accounting period.
(8)All such adjustments shall be made, whether by way of assessment or otherwise, as may be required in consequence of sub-paragraph (5).
(9)Where by virtue of this paragraph there is an amount of a registered club’s income and gains for which relief under this Part is not available, the club may, by notice to the Inland Revenue, specify which items of the income and gains are, in whole or in part, to be attributed to that amount.
If, within 30 days of being required to do so by the Inland Revenue, a registered club does not give notice under this sub-paragraph, the items of its income and gains that are to be attributed to the amount in question shall be such as the Inland Revenue may determine.
9[F110(1)Chapter 2 of Part 8 of ITA 2007 (gift aid) confers relief from income tax for donors to registered clubs (see section 430 of that Act).]U.K.
(2)Section 23 of the Inheritance Tax Act 1984 (c. 51) (gifts to charities) has effect as if—
(a)a registered club were a charity;
(b)in subsection (5) of that section (no exemption where property may become applicable for purposes that are not charitable etc), for the words from “other than charitable purposes" to the end there were substituted “other than—
(a)the purposes of the club in question;
(b)the purposes of another club that is registered as a community amateur sports club;
(c)the purposes of the governing body of an eligible sport (within the meaning of Schedule 18 to the Finance Act 2002) for the purposes of which the club in question exists; or
(d)the purposes of a charity.”.
(3)The following enactments also have effect as if a registered club were a charity—
F111(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(b)section 257 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) (gifts to charities etc);
(c)section 63(2) of the Capital Allowances Act (gifts of plant or machinery to charities etc).
Textual Amendments
F110Sch. 18 para. 9(1) substituted (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 420(3) (with Sch. 2)
F111Sch. 18 para. 9(3)(a) repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 539(4), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
10(1)This paragraph applies where a club holds property and, without disposing of it—U.K.
(a)ceases to be a registered club, or
(b)ceases to hold the property for qualifying purposes.
(2)Where this paragraph applies—
(a)the club shall be treated for the purposes of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 as having disposed of, and immediately reacquired, the property at the time of the cessation for a consideration equal to its market value at that time;
(b)any gain accruing on the deemed disposal shall be treated for the purposes of paragraph 7 as not accruing to a registered club;
(c)if and so far as any of the property represents, directly or indirectly, the consideration for the disposal of assets by the club, any gain accruing on that disposal shall be treated for the purposes of paragraph 7 as not having accrued to a registered club.
(3)An assessment in respect of a chargeable gain accruing by virtue of sub-paragraph (2) may be made at any time not more than three years after the end of the accounting period in which the club ceases to be a registered club or (as the case may be) to hold the property for qualifying purposes.
11(1)A club that applies to the Inland Revenue to be registered as a community amateur sports club shall be so registered if the Inland Revenue are satisfied that it is entitled to be.
(2)The Inland Revenue may register a club with effect from such date as they may specify (which may be before the date of the application).
(3)If it appears to the Inland Revenue that a registered club is not, or is no longer, entitled to be registered, they may terminate the club’s registration with effect from such date as they may specify (which may be before the date of the decision to terminate the registration).
(4)Where the Inland Revenue—
(a)register a club,
(b)refuse a club’s application for registration, or
(c)terminate a club’s registration,
they shall notify the club accordingly.
(5)The Inland Revenue may publish the names and addresses of registered clubs.
12A club that makes an application to be registered must—
(a)provide the Inland Revenue with such information relating to the application as they may reasonably require;
(b)if required to do so by the Inland Revenue, produce for inspection by them any books, documents or other records in the club’s possession, or under its control, that contain such information.
13(1)An appeal F112... may be brought against a decision of the Inland Revenue under paragraph 11.
(2)Notice of an appeal under this paragraph must be given—
(a)in writing,
(b)within 30 days of the date of the notification under paragraph 11(4),
(c)to the Inland Revenue.
(3)The notice of appeal must specify the grounds of appeal.
F113(4). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(5)Where the appeal is against a refusal to register a club, or against a decision to register it with effect from a particular date, the [F114tribunal] ([F115if not dismissing] the appeal) may either—
(a)direct that the club be registered with effect from a specified date, or
(b)remit the matter to the Inland Revenue for reconsideration.
(6)Where the appeal is against a decision to terminate the registration of a club, or to do so with effect from a particular date, the [F114tribunal] ([F115if not dismissing] the appeal) may either—
(a)rescind the termination,
(b)direct that the termination have effect from a specified date, or
(c)remit the matter to the Inland Revenue for reconsideration.
(7)The provisions of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) relating to appeals under the Taxes Acts shall apply to an appeal under this paragraph as they apply to those appeals.
Textual Amendments
F112Words in Sch. 18 para. 13(1) omitted (1.4.2009) by virtue of The Transfer of Tribunal Functions and Revenue and Customs Appeals Order 2009 (S.I. 2009/56), art. 1(2), Sch. 1 para. 327(2)(a)
F113Sch. 18 para. 13(4) omitted (1.4.2009) by virtue of The Transfer of Tribunal Functions and Revenue and Customs Appeals Order 2009 (S.I. 2009/56), art. 1(2), Sch. 1 para. 327(2)(b)
F114Word in Sch. 18 para. 13(5)(6) substituted (1.4.2009) by The Transfer of Tribunal Functions and Revenue and Customs Appeals Order 2009 (S.I. 2009/56), art. 1(2), Sch. 1 para. 327(2)(c)(i)
F115Words in Sch. 18 para. 13(5)(6) substituted (1.4.2009) by The Transfer of Tribunal Functions and Revenue and Customs Appeals Order 2009 (S.I. 2009/56), art. 1(2), Sch. 1 para. 327(2)(c)(ii)
14(1)For the purposes of this Schedule “eligible sport” means a sport that is designated for those purposes by Treasury order.
A sport may be so designated by reference to its appearing in a list maintained by a body specified in the order.
(2)An order under this paragraph shall be made by statutory instrument which shall be subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of the House of Commons.
15(1)Subject to sub-paragraph (2), references in this Schedule to the Inland Revenue are to any officer of the Board.
(2)References to the Inland Revenue in paragraphs 11 and 13(1), (5) and (6) are to the Board.
16In this Schedule—
(a)“dispose”, “disposal”, “gain” and “chargeable gain” shall be construed in accordance with the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12);
(b)“for qualifying purposes” means for the purposes of providing facilities for, and promoting participation in, one or more eligible sports, and “for non-qualifying purposes” shall be construed accordingly.
Section 59
1The Capital Allowances Act 2001 (c. 2) is amended as follows.
2In section 39, after the entry relating to section 45A add,
“section 45D | expenditure on cars with low CO2 emissions,”. |
3After section 45C insert—
(1)Expenditure is first-year qualifying expenditure if—
(a)it is incurred in the period beginning with 17th April 2002 and ending with 31st March 2008,
(b)it is expenditure on a car which is first registered on or after 17th April 2002 and which is unused and not second-hand,
(c)the car—
(i)is an electrically-propelled car, or
(ii)is a car with low CO2 emissions, and
(d)the expenditure is not excluded by section 46 (general exclusions).
(2)For the purposes of this section a car with low CO2 emissions is a car which satisfies the conditions in subsections (3) and (4).
(3)The first condition is that, when the car is first registered, it is so registered on the basis of an EC certificate of conformity, or a UK approval certificate, that specifies—
(a)in the case of a car other than a bi-fuel car, a CO2 emissions figure in terms of grams per kilometre driven, or
(b)in the case of a bi-fuel car, separate CO2 emissions figures in terms of grams per kilometre driven for different fuels.
(4)The second condition is that the applicable CO2 emissions figure in the case of the car does not exceed 120 grams per kilometre driven.
(5)For the purposes of subsection (4) the applicable CO2 emissions figure in the case of a car other than a bi-fuel car is—
(a)where the EC certificate of conformity or UK approval certificate specifies only one CO2 emissions figure, that figure, and
(b)where the certificate specifies more than one CO2 emissions figure, the figure specified as the CO2 emissions (combined) figure.
(6)For the purposes of subsection (4) the applicable CO2 emissions figure in the case of a bi-fuel car is—
(a)where the EC certificate of conformity or UK approval certificate specifies more than one CO2 emissions figure in relation to each fuel, the lowest CO2 emissions (combined) figure specified, and
(b)in any other case, the lowest CO2 figure specified by the certificate.
(7)The Treasury may by order amend the amount from time to time specified in subsection (4).
(8)In this section any reference to a car—
(a)includes a reference to a mechanically propelled road vehicle of a type commonly used as a hackney carriage, but
(b)does not include a reference to a motorcycle.
(9)For the purposes of this section, a car is an electrically-propelled car only if—
(a)it is propelled solely by electrical power, and
(b)that power is derived from—
(i)a source external to the vehicle, or
(ii)an electrical storage battery which is not connected to any source of power when the vehicle is in motion.
(10)In this section—
“bi-fuel car” means a car which is capable of being propelled by—
petrol and road fuel gas, or
diesel and road fuel gas;
“car” has the meaning given by section 81 (extended meaning of “car");
“diesel” means any diesel fuel within the definition in Article 2 of Directive 98/70/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council;
“EC certificate of conformity” means a certificate of conformity issued by a manufacturer under any provision of the law of a member State implementing Article 6 of Council Directive 70/156/EEC, as amended;
“petrol” has the meaning given by Article 2 of Directive 98/70/ EC of the European Parliament and of the Council;
“road fuel gas” has the same meaning as in section 168AB of ICTA;
“UK approval certificate” means a certificate issued under—
section 58(1) or (4) of the Road Traffic Act 1988, or
Article 31A(4) or (5) of the Road Traffic (Northern Ireland) Order 1981.”.
4(1)Section 46 is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (1) (expenditure which is subject to the general exclusions) after the entry relating to section 45A add “,
section 45D | (expenditure on cars with low CO2 emissions),”. |
(3)After subsection (2) (general exclusions listed for the purposes of subsection (1)) insert—
“(3)Subsection (1) is subject to the following provisions of this section.
(4)General exclusion 2 does not prevent expenditure being first-year qualifying expenditure under section 45D.”.
5In section 52(3), in the Table, after the entry relating to expenditure qualifying under section 45A add—
“Expenditure qualifying under section 45D (expenditure on cars with low CO2 emissions) | 100%”. |
6In section 74, in subsection (2) (cars to which section 74 applies) after paragraph (b) insert “, and
(c)the qualifying expenditure incurred on the provision of the car is not first-year qualifying expenditure under section 45D (expenditure on cars with low CO2 emissions)”.
Section 61
1The Capital Allowances Act 2001 (c. 2) is amended as follows.
2In section 39, after the entry relating to section 45D (which is inserted by Schedule 19 to this Act) add—
“section 45E | expenditure on plant or machinery for gas refuelling station”. |
3After section 45D (which is added by Schedule 19 to this Act) insert—
(1)Expenditure is first-year qualifying expenditure if—
(a)it is incurred in the period beginning with 17th April 2002 and ending with 31st March 2008,
(b)it is expenditure on plant or machinery for a gas refuelling station where the plant or machinery is unused and not second-hand, and
(c)it is not excluded by section 46 (general exclusions).
(2)For the purposes of this section expenditure on plant or machinery for a gas refuelling station is expenditure on plant or machinery installed at a gas refuelling station for use solely for or in connection with refuelling vehicles with natural gas or hydrogen fuel.
(3)For the purposes of subsection (2) the plant or machinery which is for use for or in connection with refuelling vehicles with natural gas or hydrogen fuel includes—
(a)any storage tank for natural gas or hydrogen fuel,
(b)any compressor, pump, control or meter used for or in connection with refuelling vehicles with natural gas or hydrogen fuel, and
(c)any equipment for dispensing natural gas or hydrogen fuel to the fuel tank of a vehicle.
(4)For the purposes of this section—
“gas refuelling station” means any premises, or that part of any premises, where vehicles are refuelled with natural gas or hydrogen fuel;
“hydrogen fuel” means a fuel consisting of gaseous or cryogenic liquid hydrogen which is used for propelling vehicles;
“vehicle” means a mechanically propelled road vehicle.”.
4In section 46, in subsection (1) (expenditure which is subject to the general exclusions) after the entry relating to section 45D (which is added by Schedule 19 to this Act) add—
“section 45E | (expenditure on plant or machinery for gas refuelling station)”. |
5In section 52(3), in the Table, after the entry relating to expenditure qualifying under section 45D (which is added by Schedule 19 to this Act) add—
“Expenditure qualifying under section 45E (expenditure on plant or machinery for gas refuelling station) | 100%”. |
Section 63
1Part 2 of the Capital Allowances Act 2001 (c. 2) (plant and machinery allowances) is amended as follows.
2In section 39, after the entry relating to section 45E (which is added by Schedule 20 to this Act) add “, or
section 45F | expenditure on plant and machinery for use wholly in a ring fence trade.”. |
3After section 45E (which is inserted by Schedule 20 to this Act) insert—
(1)Expenditure is first-year qualifying expenditure if—
(a)it is incurred on or after 17th April 2002,
(b)it is incurred by a company,
(c)it is incurred on the provision of plant or machinery for use wholly for the purposes of a ring fence trade, and
(d)it is not excluded by section 46 (general exclusions).
(2)This section is subject to section 45G (plant or machinery used for less than five years in a ring fence trade).
(3)In this section “ring fence trade” means a ring fence trade in respect of which tax is chargeable under section 501A of the Taxes Act 1988 (supplementary charge in respect of ring fence trades).”.
4After section 45F insert—
(1)Expenditure incurred by a company on the provision of plant or machinery is to be treated as never having been first-year qualifying expenditure under section 45F if the plant or machinery—
(a)is at no time in the relevant period used in a ring fence trade carried on by the company or a company connected with it, or
(b)is at any time in the relevant period used for a purpose other than that of a ring fence trade carried on by the company or a company connected with it.
(2)For the purposes of this section “the relevant period” means whichever of the following periods, beginning with the incurring of the expenditure, first ends, namely—
(a)the period ending with the fifth anniversary of the incurring of the expenditure, or
(b)the period ending with the day preceding the first occasion on which the plant or machinery, after becoming owned by the company which incurred the expenditure, is not owned by a company which is either that company or a company connected with it.
(3)All such assessments and adjustments of assessments are to be made as are necessary to give effect to subsection (1).
(4)If a person who has made a return becomes aware that, after making it, anything in it has become incorrect because of the operation of this section, he must give notice to the Inland Revenue specifying how the return needs to be amended.
(5)The notice must be given within 3 months beginning with the day on which the person first became aware that anything in the return had become incorrect because of the operation of this section.
(6)In this section “ring fence trade” has the same meaning as in section 45F.”.
5In section 46, in subsection (1) (expenditure which is subject to the general exclusions) after the entry relating to section 45E (which is added by Schedule 20 to this Act) add “, or
section 45F | (expenditure on plant and machinery for use wholly in a ring fence trade).”. |
6In section 52(3), in the Table, after the entry relating to expenditure qualifying under section 45E (which is added by Schedule 20 to this Act) add—
“Expenditure qualifying under section 45F (expenditure on plant and machinery for use wholly in a ring fence trade) which is long-life asset expenditure | 24% |
Expenditure qualifying under section 45F (expenditure on plant and machinery for use wholly in a ring fence trade) other than long-life asset expenditure | 100%”. |
7(1)The Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) is amended as follows.
(2)In the second column of the Table in section 98, in the entry relating to requirements imposed by provisions of the Capital Allowances Act, after “45B(5) and (6)," insert “ 45G(4) and (5), ”.
8Part 5 of the Capital Allowances Act 2001 (c. 2) (mineral extraction allowances) is amended as follows.
9After section 416, insert the following Chapter—
First-year qualifying expenditure
General
A first-year allowance is not available unless the qualifying expenditure is first-year qualifying expenditure under section 416B (expenditure incurred wholly for purposes of a ring fence trade).
Types of expenditure which may qualify for first year allowances
(1)Expenditure is first-year qualifying expenditure if—
(a)it is incurred on or after 17th April 2002,
(b)it is incurred by a company,
(c)it is incurred wholly for the purposes of a ring fence trade, and
(d)it is not excluded by—
(i)subsection (2) (acquisition of mineral asset), or
(ii)subsection (3) (acquisition of asset representing expenditure of connected company).
(2)Expenditure is not first-year qualifying expenditure under this section if it is expenditure on acquiring a mineral asset.
(3)Expenditure is not first-year qualifying expenditure under this section if it is expenditure incurred by a company on the acquisition of an asset representing expenditure incurred by a company connected with that company.
(4)To the extent that references in this section to an asset representing expenditure incurred by a company include a reference to an asset representing expenditure on mineral exploration and access, they also include a reference to any results obtained from any search, exploration or inquiry on which any such expenditure was incurred.
(5)In this section “ring fence trade” means a ring fence trade in respect of which tax is chargeable under section 501A of the Taxes Act 1988 (supplementary charge in respect of ring fence trades).
Supplementary
(1)In determining whether expenditure is first-year qualifying expenditure under this Chapter, any effect of the provisions specified in subsection (2) on the time at which the expenditure is to be treated as incurred is to be disregarded.
(2)The provisions are—
(a)section 400(4) (which treats certain pre-trading expenditure as incurred on the first day of trading), and
(b)section 434 (which treats certain other expenditure incurred for the purposes of a trade about to be carried on as incurred on that day).”.
10At the beginning of Chapter 6 (allowances and charges) insert—
“First-year allowances
(1)A person is entitled to a first-year allowance in respect of first-year qualifying expenditure if the expenditure is incurred in a chargeable period to which this Act applies.
(2)Any first-year allowance is made for the chargeable period in which the first-year qualifying expenditure is incurred.
(3)The amount of the allowance is a percentage of the first-year qualifying expenditure in respect of which the allowance is made, as shown in the Table—
Amount of first-year allowances
Type of first-year qualifying expenditure | Amount |
---|---|
Expenditure qualifying under section 416B (expenditure incurred wholly for the purposes of a ring fence trade) | 100% |
(4)A person who is entitled to a first-year allowance may claim the allowance in respect of the whole or a part of the first-year qualifying expenditure.
(5)This section is subject to section 416E (artificially inflated claims for first-year allowances).”.
11After section 416D insert—
(1)To the extent that a transaction is attributable to arrangements entered into wholly or mainly for a disqualifying purpose, it shall be disregarded in determining for a chargeable period the amount of any first-year allowance to which a person is entitled.
(2)For the purposes of this section, arrangements are entered into wholly or mainly for a “disqualifying purpose” if their main object, or one of their main objects, is to enable a person to obtain—
(a)a first-year allowance to which he would not otherwise be entitled, or
(b)a first-year allowance of a greater amount than that to which he would otherwise be entitled.
(3)In this section “arrangements” includes any scheme, agreement or understanding, whether or not legally enforceable.”.
12(1)Section 418 is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (4) (amount of balancing charge) after paragraph (b) insert the following as a second sentence—
“Where a person is liable to a balancing charge in respect of first-year qualifying expenditure for the chargeable period in which he incurred the expenditure, any first-year allowance made in respect of the expenditure shall be treated for the purposes of paragraph (b) as if it were an allowance for an earlier chargeable period.”.
13(1)Section 419 is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (1) (amount of qualifying expenditure which is unrelieved qualifying expenditure for the chargeable period in which the expenditure is incurred) for “the whole of it" substitute—
“(a)the whole of it, unless the expenditure is first-year qualifying expenditure, or
(b)if the expenditure is first-year qualifying expenditure, none of it,
but paragraph (b) is subject to subsections (3) to (5). ”.
(3)After subsection (2) insert—
“(3)If, in the case of expenditure which is first-year qualifying expenditure, a disposal receipt falls to be brought into account for the chargeable period in which the expenditure is incurred (“the initial period”), subsection (4) below applies.
(4)Where this subsection applies, the unrelieved balance of the expenditure shall be taken to be unrelieved qualifying expenditure for the initial period, but only for the purpose specified in subsection (5).
(5)The purpose is that of determining in accordance with sections 417 and 418—
(a)any question whether the person who incurred the expenditure—
(i)is entitled to a balancing allowance for the initial period, or
(ii)is liable to a balancing charge for that period, and
(b)if so, the amount of that balancing allowance or balancing charge.
(6)In this section “the unrelieved balance of the expenditure” means so much of the first-year qualifying expenditure in question as remains after deducting the amount of any first-year allowance given in respect of the whole or any part of that expenditure.”.
Section 64
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F116Sch. 22 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 540, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 79
1Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) (loan relationships) is amended in accordance with the following provisions of this Part.
F1172. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F117Sch. 23 para. 2 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F1183. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F118Sch. 23 para. 3 repealed (with effect in accordance with Sch. 11 Pt. 2(6) Note 3 of the amending Act) by Finance (No. 2) Act 2005 (c. 22), Sch. 11 Pt. 2(6)
F1194. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F119Sch. 23 para. 4 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F120Sch. 23 para. 5 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3), Sch. 10 para. 9(2)(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1216. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F121Sch. 23 para. 6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F1227. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F122Sch. 23 para. 7 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F1238. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F123Sch. 23 para. 8 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1249. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F124Sch. 23 paras. 9-15 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F12410. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F124Sch. 23 paras. 9-15 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F12411. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F124Sch. 23 paras. 9-15 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F12412. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F124Sch. 23 paras. 9-15 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F12413. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F124Sch. 23 paras. 9-15 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F12414. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F124Sch. 23 paras. 9-15 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F12415. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F124Sch. 23 paras. 9-15 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
16In Schedule 15 (savings and transitional provisions) omit paragraphs 22 to 24.
17(1)Section 494 of the Taxes Act 1988 is amended in accordance with the following provisions of this paragraph.
(2)Subsection (2) (debits not to be brought into account in a manner which results in the reduction of what would otherwise be the company’s ring fence profits, except as provided in the subsequent paragraphs) is amended as follows.
(3)In paragraph (c) (debits in respect of a deemed loan relationship)—
(a)for “a loan relationship deemed to exist for the purposes of section 100 of that Act,” substitute “ a relationship to which section 100 of that Act applies, ”;
(b)after “to the extent that” insert “ (i) ”; and
(c)after “above;” insert “or
(ii)the exchange loss arising from that relationship is in respect of a money debt on which the interest payable (if any) is, or would be, such expenditure;
as the case may be; ”.
(4)In paragraph (d) (debits in respect of debtor relationship which is creditor relationship of associated company)—
(a)for “in the case of debits” substitute “ in the case of a net debit for an accounting period ”; and
(b)for “the debit”, in both places where occurring, substitute “ the net debit ”.
(5)In the second sentence of that subsection (interpretation) for “any loan relationship deemed to exist for the purposes of section 100 of that Act” substitute “ any relationship to which section 100 of that Act applies ”.
(6)After the second sentence insert the following as a third sentence—
“For the purposes of paragraph (d) above, the net debit for an accounting period in respect of a debtor relationship of a company is the amount if any by which—
(i)the aggregate of the debits for the period in respect of the relationship, exceeds
(ii)the credits in respect of exchange gains arising from the relationship for the period.”.
(7)After subsection (2) insert—
“(2ZA)Credits in respect of exchange gains from a company’s loan relationships shall not be brought into account for the purposes of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 in respect of any loan relationship of a company in any manner that results in an increase of what would otherwise be the company’s ring fence profits, except to the extent that, if the credit had been a debit in respect of an exchange loss from the relationship, it would have been brought into account by virtue of any of paragraphs (a) to (c) of subsection (2) above.”.
(8)In subsection (2A) (debits prevented from reducing ring fence profits by subsection (2) to be brought into account for purposes of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) as non-trading debits)—
(a)after “Where any debit” insert “ or credit ”;
(b)in paragraph (b)—
(i)after “in accordance with subsection (2)” insert “ or (2ZA) ”; and
(ii)after “reduction” insert “ or, as the case may be, increase ”; and
(c)in the closing words—
(i)after “that debit” insert “ or credit ”; and
(ii)after “non-trading debit” insert “ or, as the case may be, non-trading credit ”.
(9)After subsection (2A) insert—
“(2B)Where, in accordance with subsection (2) above, any proportion (including the whole) of a net debit, within the meaning of paragraph (d) of that subsection, cannot be brought into account in a manner that results in any reduction of what would otherwise be the company’s ring fence profits, subsection (2A) above shall apply—
(a)separately in relation to that proportion of each of the debits and each of the credits brought into account in determining the amount of the net debit, and
(b)on the assumption that that proportion of each of those debits and credits falls within paragraph (b) of that subsection.”.
18(1)In section 501A of the Taxes Act 1988, subsection (5) (computation of financing costs) is amended as follows.
(2)In paragraph (a) (costs giving rise to debits in respect of debtor relationships) after “(loan relationships)” insert “ , other than debits in respect of exchange losses from such relationships (see section 103(1A) and (1B) of that Act) ”.
(3)For paragraph (b) (exchange gain or loss, within the meaning of Chapter 2 of Part 2 of the Finance Act 1993 (c. 34), in relation to debt finance) substitute—
“(b)any exchange gain or loss from a debtor relationship, within the meaning of that Chapter (see section 103(1A) and (1B) of that Act), in relation to debt finance;”.
F12519. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F125Sch. 23 para. 19 repealed (7.4.2005) by Finance Act 2005 (c. 7), Sch. 11 Pt. 2(6)
20(1)Section 798B of the Taxes Act 1988 (adjustments of interest and dividends for spared tax etc) is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (5) (meaning of “qualifying losses”) for paragraph (a) (exchange losses under Finance Act 1993) substitute—
“(a)exchange losses falling to be brought into account as debits for the purposes of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (loan relationships); and”.
21(1)In Schedule 28AA to the Taxes Act 1988 (provision not at arm’s length) paragraph 8 (foreign exchange gains and losses etc) is amended as follows.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) (exceptions)—
(a)for “Subject to sub-paragraph (2)” substitute “ Subject to sub-paragraph (3) ”; and
(b)for paragraph (a) (which relates to Chapter 2 of Part 2 of the Finance Act 1993) substitute—
“(a)Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (loan relationships) in respect of exchange gains or losses from loan relationships (as defined in section 103(1A) and (1B) of that Act), or”.
(3)For sub-paragraph (2) (saving for certain provisions of sections 136 and 136A of the Finance Act 1993 (application of arm’s length test)) substitute—
“(3)Sub-paragraph (1) above shall not affect so much of paragraph 11A of Schedule 9 to the Finance Act 1996 (loan relationships: exchange gains or losses where loan not on arm’s length terms) as has effect by reference to whether profits or losses fall to be computed by virtue of this Schedule as if the whole or any part of a loan had not been made.”.
22(1)The Finance Act 1995 (c. 4) is amended as follows.
(2)Omit section 131(which made transitional provision in relation to exchange gains and losses and which is spent).
(3)In Part 2 of Schedule 24 (amendments of certain enactments) in paragraph 7 (commencement on day appointed under section 165(7)(b) of Finance Act 1993) for the words following “come into force on” substitute “ 23rd March 1995 ”.
23(1)Schedule 22 to the Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) is amended as follows.
(2)In paragraph 50 (relevant shipping income: certain interests etc) in sub-paragraph (2) (income to which paragraph 50 applies) at the end of paragraph (a) insert “ and ”.
(3)In paragraph 63 (meaning of “finance costs”) in sub-paragraph (2)(c) (exchange gain or loss) for “within the meaning of Chapter II of Part II of the Finance Act 1993” substitute “ within the meaning given by section 103(1A) of the Finance Act 1996 ”.
24(1)Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 (gains and losses of a company from intangible fixed assets) is amended as follows.
(2)In paragraph 75 (assets entirely excluded: financial assets) in sub-paragraph (3) for paragraph (a) (money debts) substitute—
“(a)loan relationships;”.
F12625. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F126Sch. 23 para. 25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 541(2), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Pts. 1, 2, Sch. 2 para. 57)
26(1)The repeal of sections 139 to 143 of the Finance Act 1993 (c. 34) (foreign exchange gains and losses) does not prevent the making of a claim under section 139 of that Act (deferral of unrealised gains) by a company in respect of a gain accruing in an accrual period which begins with, or at any time in, the last accounting period of the company which begins before 1st October 2002; but any such claim shall have effect subject to the following provisions of this paragraph and (subject to regulations under section 81) regulations under Chapter 2 of Part 2 of that Act.
(2)Amounts which, but for the repeal of subsections (4) to (10) of section 140 of the Finance Act 1993, would fall to be treated by virtue of those subsections as exchange gains for an accrual period which consists of, or falls in, an accounting period beginning on or after 1st October 2002—
(a)shall be brought into account for that accounting period as if they were credits falling for the purposes of [F127Part 5 of the Corporation Tax Act 2009] to be brought into account in respect of the company’s loan relationships;
(b)shall be treated for the purposes of [F128that Part] as non-trading credits, to the extent that they would, but for the repeal of subsections (5), (8) and (9) of section 140 of the Finance Act 1993, have fallen to be treated by virtue of those subsections as non-trading exchange gains; and
(c)except as provided by paragraph (b), shall be brought into account under [F129section 297(2) of the Corporation Tax Act 2009] (trading credits).
(3)Before the expiration of the period of 2 years following the end of its first accounting period beginning on or after 1st October 2002, a company may elect for any amounts that would otherwise fall to be brought into account for that accounting period in accordance with paragraph (a) of sub-paragraph (2) instead to be brought into account in accordance with that sub-paragraph, but—
(a)over the first 6 accounting periods of the company which begin on or after 1st October 2002; and
(b)in instalments of an equal amount for each such accounting period.
(4)If a company—
(a)makes an election under sub-paragraph (3), but
(b)ceases to be within the charge to corporation tax before six accounting periods of the company which begin on or after 1st October 2002 have elapsed,
any instalment under that sub-paragraph which does not fall to be brought into account for an earlier accounting period shall be brought into account for the accounting period in which the company ceases to be within the charge to corporation tax.
F130(5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F127Words in Sch. 23 para. 26(2)(a) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 541(3)(a)(i) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F128Words in Sch. 23 para. 26(2)(b) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 541(3)(a)(ii) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F129Words in Sch. 23 para. 26(2)(c) substituted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 541(3)(a)(iii) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F130Sch. 23 para. 26(5) repealed (with effect in accordance with Sch. 11 Pt. 2(6) Note 3 of the amending Act) by Finance (No. 2) Act 2005 (c. 22), Sch. 11 Pt. 2(6)
Section 80
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C2Sch. 24 extended (retrospective to 30.9.2002) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 177(4)(8)(11)
F1311. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F131Sch. 24 paras. 1-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1312. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F131Sch. 24 paras. 1-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1313. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F131Sch. 24 paras. 1-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1314. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F131Sch. 24 paras. 1-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1315. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F131Sch. 24 paras. 1-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1316. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F131Sch. 24 paras. 1-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
7(1)Section 226 of the Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) (provisions which are not to apply to corporate members of Lloyd’s) is amended as follows.
(2)Subsection (1) (which prevents sections 92 to 95 of the Finance Act 1993 (c. 34) from applying) shall cease to have effect (and sections 92 to 94AB of that Act shall accordingly apply for the purposes of computing for the purposes of corporation tax the profits or losses of a corporate member’s underwriting business).
Section 82
1Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) (loan relationships) is amended in accordance with the following provisions of this Part of this Schedule.
F1322. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F1323. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F1334. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F133Sch. 25 paras. 4-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1335. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F133Sch. 25 paras. 4-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1336. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F133Sch. 25 paras. 4-6 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F1327. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F1328. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F1329. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13410. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F134Sch. 25 para. 10 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F13211. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13212. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13213. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13214. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13215. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13216. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13217. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13218. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13219. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13220. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13521. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F135Sch. 25 para. 21 omitted (with effect in accordance with Sch. 14 para. 18 of the amending Act) by virtue of Finance Act 2008 (c. 9), Sch. 14 para. 17(k)
F13222. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13223. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13224. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13225. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F132Sch. 25 paras. 2-25 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13626. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F136Sch. 25 para. 26 repealed (7.4.2005) by Finance Act 2005 (c. 7), Sch. 11 Pt. 2(5)
F13727. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13728. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13729. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13730. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13731. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13832. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F138Sch. 25 para. 32 repealed (19.7.2007) by Finance Act 2007 (c. 11), Sch. 27 Pt. 2(14)
F13733. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13734. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13735. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F13736. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F137Sch. 25 paras. 27-36 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
37(1)Schedule 10 (collective investment schemes) is amended as follows.
(2)For paragraph 1 substitute—
(1)Where any profits, gains or losses arising to an investment trust from a creditor relationship for an accounting period are carried to or sustained by a capital reserve in accordance with the Statement of Recommended Practice used for that accounting period, those profits, gains or losses must not be brought into account as credits or debits for the purposes of this Chapter, notwithstanding section 84(2)(b) of this Act.
(2)Where any profits, gains or losses arising to a venture capital trust from a creditor relationship for an accounting period—
(a)are carried to or sustained by a capital reserve in accordance with the Statement of Recommended Practice used for the accounting period as if the venture capital trust were an investment trust, or
(b)would be carried to or sustained by a capital reserve if the venture capital trust were an investment trust and were using that Statement of Recommended Practice,
those profits, gains or losses must not be brought into account as credits or debits for the purposes of this Chapter, notwithstanding section 84(2)(b) of this Act.
(3)For the purposes of this paragraph, the “Statement of Recommended Practice” used for an accounting period is—
(a)in relation to an accounting period for which it is permitted to be used, the Statement of Recommended Practice relating to Investment Trust Companies, issued by the Association of Investment Trust Companies in December 1995, as from time to time modified, amended or revised, or
(b)in relation to any accounting period for which it is permitted to be used, any subsequent Statement of Recommended Practice relating to investment trusts, as from time to time modified, amended or revised.”.
38(1)Schedule 10 (collective investment schemes) is amended as follows.
(2)For paragraph 2 (which makes special provision in relation to authorised unit trusts and is applied to open-ended investment companies by regulations under section 152 of the Finance Act 1995 (c. 4)) and the heading immediately preceding it substitute—
(1)Where any profits, gains or losses arising to an authorised unit trust from a creditor relationship in an accounting period are capital profits, gains or losses, those profits, gains or losses must not be brought into account as credits or debits for the purposes of this Chapter, notwithstanding section 84(2)(b) of this Act.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph, capital profits, gains or losses arising from a creditor relationship in an accounting period are such profits, gains or losses arising from a creditor relationship as fall to be dealt with under—
(a)the heading “net gains/losses on investments during the period”, or
(b)the heading “other gains/losses”,
in the statement of total return for the accounting period.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) above, the statement of total return for an accounting period is the statement of total return which, in accordance with the Statement of Recommended Practice used for the accounting period, must be included in the accounts contained in the annual report of the authorised unit trust which deals with the accounting period.
(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) above, “Statement of Recommended Practice” means—
(a)in relation to any accounting period for which it is required or permitted to be used, the Statement of Recommended Practice relating to Authorised Unit Trust Schemes issued by the Investment Management Regulatory Organisation Limited in January 1997, as from time to time modified, amended or revised; or
(b)in relation to any accounting period for which it is required or permitted to be used, any subsequent Statement of Recommended Practice relating to authorised unit trust schemes, as from time to time modified, amended or revised.
(5)The Treasury may by order amend this paragraph so as to alter the definition of capital profits, gains or losses in consequence of the modification, amendment, revision or replacement of a Statement of Recommended Practice.
(6)The power to make an order under this paragraph includes power—
(a)to make different provision for different cases; and
(b)to make such consequential, supplementary, incidental or transitional provision, or savings, as appear to the Treasury to be necessary or expedient (including provision amending any enactment or any instrument made under any enactment).
(1)Where any profits, gains or losses arising to an open-ended investment company from a creditor relationship in an accounting period are capital profits, gains or losses, those profits, gains or losses must not be brought into account as credits or debits for the purposes of this Chapter, notwithstanding section 84(2)(b) of this Act.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph, capital profits, gains or losses arising from a creditor relationship in an accounting period are such profits, gains or losses arising from a creditor relationship as fall to be dealt with under—
(a)the heading “net gains/losses on investments during the period”, or
(b)the heading “other gains/losses”,
in the statement of total return for the accounting period.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2) above, the statement of total return for an accounting period is the statement of total return which, in accordance with the Statement of Recommended Practice used for the accounting period, must be included in the accounts contained in the annual report of the open-ended investment company which deals with the accounting period.
(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (3) above, “Statement of Recommended Practice” means—
(a)in relation to any accounting period for which it is required or permitted to be used, the Statement of Recommended Practice relating to Open-Ended Investment Companies issued by the Financial Services Authority in November 2000, as from time to time modified, amended or revised; or
(b)in relation to any accounting period for which it is required or permitted to be used, any subsequent Statement of Recommended Practice relating to open-ended investment companies, as from time to time modified, amended or revised.
(5)The Treasury may by order amend this paragraph so as to alter the definition of capital profits, gains or losses in consequence of the modification, amendment, revision or replacement of a Statement of Recommended Practice.
(6)The power to make an order under this paragraph includes power—
(a)to make different provision for different cases; and
(b)to make such consequential, supplementary, incidental or transitional provision, or savings, as appear to the Treasury to be necessary or expedient (including provision amending any enactment or any instrument made under any enactment).”.
39For paragraph 3 of that Schedule substitute—
“3(1)For the purposes of paragraph 5(1) of Schedule 27 to the Taxes Act 1988 (computation of UK equivalent profit), the assumptions to be made in determining what, for any period, would be the total profits of an offshore fund are to include the assumptions in sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) below.
(2)The first assumption is that the provisions of this Chapter so far as they relate to the creditor relationships of a company do not apply for the purposes of corporation tax in computing the profits or loss of an offshore fund.
(3)The second assumption is that for the purposes of corporation tax the profits and gains, and losses, that are to be taken to arise from the creditor relationships of an offshore fund are to be computed—
(a)in accordance with the provisions applicable, in the case of unauthorised unit trusts, for the purposes of income tax; and
(b)as if the provisions so applicable had effect in relation to an accounting period of an offshore fund as they have effect, in the case of unauthorised unit trusts, in relation to a year of assessment.
(4)In this paragraph “unauthorised unit trust” means the trustees of any unit trust scheme which is not an authorised unit trust but is a unit trust scheme for the purposes of section 469 of the Taxes Act 1988.”.
F13940. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F139Sch. 25 para. 40 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
41(1)In Schedule 15 (loan relationships: savings and transitional provisions) paragraph 11 is amended as follows.
(2)After sub-paragraph (2) insert—
“(2A)If, in a case where the continuing loan relationship is a creditor relationship,—
(a)the company acquired its rights under the relationship on or before 31st March 1996 by virtue of an arm’s length transaction,
(b)for the accounting period in which it acquired those rights—
(i)there was no connection (as defined in sub-paragraph (2C) below) between the company and the person from whom the company acquired the asset, but
(ii)there was such a connection between the company and a company standing in the position of a debtor as respects the money debt, and
(c)there had been no such connection between the companies mentioned in paragraph (b)(ii) above at any time in the period which—
(i)begins 4 years before the date on which the company acquired those rights, and
(ii)ends twelve months before that date,
this paragraph shall have effect as if the amount mentioned in sub-paragraph (2)(b) above were an amount equal to the greater of the amounts mentioned in sub-paragraph (2B) below.
(2B)Those amounts are—
(a)the fair value of the rights at the time when the company ceases to be a party to the loan relationship; and
(b)the fair value of the rights on 1st April 1996.
(2C)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2A) above there is a connection between a company and another person at any time if at that time—
(a)the other person is a company and one of the companies has control of the other,
(b)the other person is a company and both companies are under the control of the same person, or
(c)the company is a close company and the other person is a participator in that company or the associate of a person who is such a participator,
and there is a connection between a company and another person for an accounting period if there is a connection (within paragraphs (a) to (c) above) between the company and the person at any time in that accounting period.
(2D)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2C) above—
(a)subsections (2) to (6) of section 416 of the Taxes Act 1988 (meaning of control) shall apply as they apply for the purposes of Part 11 of that Act;
(b)subject to paragraph (c) below, “participator” and “associate” have the meaning given for the purposes of that Part by section 417 of that Act;
(c)a person shall not be regarded as a participator in relation to a company by reason only that he is a loan creditor of the company.”.
42In Schedule 15, after paragraph 11 (other adjustments in the case of chargeable assets etc) insert—
11A(1)This paragraph applies where, in the case of any asset representing in whole or in part a loan relationship of a company, an amount representing a deemed allowable loss would (apart from this paragraph) fall or have fallen to be brought into account in accordance with paragraph 8(3) above for an accounting period (whenever beginning or ending), but for section 251(4) of the 1992 Act (no allowable loss on disposal of debt acquired from connected person).
(2)Where this paragraph applies, the amount of any credit falling within sub-paragraph (3) below shall be treated for the purposes of this Chapter as reduced (but not below nil) by the amount described in sub-paragraph (1) above.
(3)A credit falls within this sub-paragraph if (apart from this paragraph)—
(a)the credit falls to be given by virtue of paragraph 11(3)(a) above for an accounting period beginning on or after 1st October 2002; and
(b)the loan relationship mentioned in paragraph 11(1)(a) above in the case of the credit is the same loan relationship as the one mentioned in sub-paragraph (1) above.”.
43The Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.
44In section 77(2)(a) (meaning of “qualifying loan” etc) omit sub-paragraph (ii) (interest deductible under section 338 against total profits).
45In section 403ZC (amounts eligible for group relief: non-trading deficit on loan relationships) omit subsection (2) (which refers to a claim under section 83(2) of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8)).
F14046. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F140Sch. 25 para. 46 repealed (with effect in accordance with Sch. 43 Pt. 3(12) Note 1 of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), Sch. 43 Pt. 3(12)
F14147. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F141Sch. 25 para. 47 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F14248. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F142Sch. 25 para. 48 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
49(1)Section 510A is amended as follows.
(2)In paragraph (b) of subsection (3) (charging tax in respect of gains) for “gains” substitute “ chargeable gains ”.
(3)After that paragraph add
“;but paragraph (a) above is subject to subsection (6A) below.”.
(4)After subsection (6) (trade or profession carried on by grouping treated for tax on income and gains as carried on by a partnership) insert—
“(6A)Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (loan relationships) shall have effect in relation to a grouping as it has effect in relation to a partnership (see in particular section 87A of, and paragraphs 19 and 20 of Schedule 9 to, that Act).”.
F14350. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F143Sch. 25 para. 50 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F14451. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F144Sch. 25 para. 51 repealed (with effect in accordance with Sch. 11 Pt. 2(8) Note of the amending Act) by Finance (No. 2) Act 2005 (c. 22), Sch. 11 Pt. 2(8)
F14552. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F145Sch. 25 para. 52 repealed (19.7.2007) by Finance Act 2007 (c. 11), Sch. 27 Pt. 2(14)
F14653. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F146Sch. 25 para. 53 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
54In section 797, in subsection (3B) (amounts that must be allocated to trading profits) in paragraph (b) (claims under section 83(2)(d) of the Finance Act 1996) for “a claim under subsection (2)(d) of” substitute “ subsection (3A) of ”.
55(1)Section 797A is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (5) (which specifies certain amounts under section 83 of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) which are to be aggregated for the purposes of subsection (4))—
(a)in paragraph (a)—
(i)for “(2)(b), (c) or (d)” substitute “ (2)(c) ”; and
(ii)for the words from “(group relief” to “deficits)” substitute “ (deficit carried back and set against profits) ”;
(b)after paragraph (a) insert—
“(aa)so much of any non-trading deficit for that period as is surrendered as group relief by virtue of section 403 of the Taxes Act 1988; and”;
and
(c)in paragraph (b), for “(3)” substitute “ (3A) ”.
(3)In subsection (6), for “in pursuance of a claim under section 83(2)(d)” substitute “ under section 83(3A) ”.
56(1)Section 842 is amended as follows.
(2)In paragraph (a) of subsection (1) (income must be wholly or mainly eligible investment income)—
(a)after “the company’s income” insert “ (as determined in accordance with subsection (1AB) below) ”; and
(b)after “eligible investment income” insert “ (as so determined) ”.
(3)In paragraph (e) of subsection (1) (company must not retain more than 15% of eligible investment income)—
(a)for “more than” substitute “ an amount which is greater than ”; and
(b)after “eligible investment income” insert “ (determined in accordance with subsection (1AB) below) ”.
(4)After subsection (1AA) insert—
“(1AB)In determining for the purposes of paragraph (a) or (e) of subsection (1) above (and accordingly of subsection (2A)(b) below)—
(a)the amount of a company’s income, or
(b)the amount of income which a company derives from shares or securities,
the amounts to be brought into account under Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 in respect of the company’s loan relationships shall be determined without reference to any debtor relationships of the company.”.
F14757. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F147Sch. 25 para. 57 repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 421, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
58(1)Schedule 28A is amended as follows.
(2)In paragraph 6(dc) (amounts in issue for the purposes of section 768B: non-trading deficit carried forward under section 83(3) of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8)) for “83(3)” substitute “ 83(3A) ”.
(3)In paragraph 7(1)(d) (apportionment for section 768B in case of debits falling to be brought into account otherwise than on the assumption that interest does not accrue until paid) omit “and” immediately preceding sub-paragraph (iii) and at the end of that sub-paragraph insert “, and
(iv)so falls to be brought into account without any adjustment under paragraph 17 or 18 of that Schedule (debit relating to amount of discount referable to the relevant accounting period to be brought into account instead for the accounting period in which the security is redeemed),”.
(4)In paragraph 7(1)(e) (apportionment for section 768B in case of debits falling to be brought into account on the assumption that interest does not accrue until paid) omit “and” immediately preceding sub-paragraph (iii) and at the end of that sub-paragraph insert “, and
(iv)so falls to be brought into account with such an adjustment as is mentioned in paragraph (d)(iv) above,”.
(5)Omit paragraph 7(2) (which relates to charges consisting of interest and which accordingly has no further application).
(6)In paragraph 11(1) (debits that fall within paragraph 11)—
F148(a). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(b)in paragraph (c) (accounting period in which the debit would have been brought into account, apart from the sub-paragraph mentioned in paragraph (b)) for “apart from that sub-paragraph” substitute “ apart from paragraphs 2(2), 17 and 18 of that Schedule, ”.
(7)In paragraph 13(1)(ec) (amounts in issue for the purposes of section 768C: non-trading deficit carried forward under section 83(3) of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8)) for “83(3)” substitute “ 83(3A) ”.
(8)In paragraph 16(1)(d) (manner of apportionment in case of debits falling to be brought into account otherwise than on the assumption that interest does not accrue until paid) omit “and” immediately preceding sub-paragraph (iii) and at the end of that sub-paragraph insert “, and
(iv)so falls to be brought into account without any adjustment under paragraph 17 or 18 of that Schedule (debit relating to amount of discount referable to the relevant accounting period to be brought into account instead for the accounting period in which the security is redeemed),”.
F149(9). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
(10)Omit paragraph 16(2) (which relates to charges consisting of interest and which accordingly has no further application).
Textual Amendments
F148Sch. 25 para. 58(6)(a) repealed (with effect in accordance with art. 1(2) of the amending S.I.) by The Finance Act 2004, Sections 38 to 40 and 45 and Schedule 6 (Consequential Amendment of Enactments) Order 2004 (S.I. 2004/2310), art. 1(2), Sch. para. 66(2)
F149Sch. 25 para. 58(9) repealed (with effect in accordance with art. 1(2) of the amending S.I.) by The Finance Act 2004, Sections 38 to 40 and 45 and Schedule 6 (Consequential Amendment of Enactments) Order 2004 (S.I. 2004/2310), art. 1(2), Sch. para. 66(3)
59(1)Schedule 6 to the Finance Act 1988 (c. 39) is amended as follows.
(2)In consequence of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (loan relationships) in paragraph 3 (abolition of Schedule D election etc) omit—
(a)sub-paragraphs (3)(a), (4)(a) and (5)(a) and (b);
(b)in sub-paragraph (5), in the words following paragraph (c), the word “group”; and
(c)sub-paragraph (6).
60(1)Section 40 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) is amended as follows.
(2)After subsection (3) add—
“(4)In consequence of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) (loan relationships) this section does not have effect in relation to interest referable to an accounting period ending on or after 1st April 1996.”.
F15061. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F150Sch. 25 paras. 61-64 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 542, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F15061A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F150Sch. 25 paras. 61-64 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 542, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F15062. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F150Sch. 25 paras. 61-64 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 542, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F15063. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F150Sch. 25 paras. 61-64 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 542, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F15064. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F150Sch. 25 paras. 61-64 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 542, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 83
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F151Sch. 26 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 543, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 83
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C3Sch. 27 extended (retrospective to 30.9.2002) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 177(4)(8)(11)
1The Taxes Act 1988 is amended as follows.
2U.K.In section 15(1) (Schedule A) in paragraph 2(3) of Schedule A (profits of Schedule A business computed without regard to certain items) for the third indent (which relates to qualifying payments within Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994 (c. 9)) substitute—
“—credits or debits within Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002 (derivative contracts).”.
F1523U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F152Sch. 27 para. 3 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
4F153(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .U.K.
(2)After subsection (1A) of that section insert—
“(1B)If, apart from section 143(1) of the 1992 Act or section 128(2) above, gains arising in the course of dealing in financial futures or in qualifying options would constitute, for the purposes of the Corporation Tax Acts, profits and gains chargeable to tax under Case V or VI of Schedule D, then any loss arising in the course of that dealing shall not be allowable against profits and gains which are chargeable to tax under Case V or VI of Schedule D.”.
Textual Amendments
F153Sch. 27 para. 4(1) repealed (6.4.2005) by Income Tax (Trading and Other Income) Act 2005 (c. 5), s. 883(1), Sch. 3 (with Sch. 2)
F1545U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F154Sch. 27 para. 5 repealed (19.7.2007) by Finance Act 2007 (c. 11), Sch. 27 Pt. 2(10)
6U.K.Omit section 468AA (authorised unit trusts: futures and options).
7(1)Section 468L (interest distributions) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (9) (meaning of “qualifying investments”) after paragraph (e) insert—
“(f)derivative contracts whose underlying subject matter consists wholly of any one or more of the matters referred to in paragraphs (a) to (e) above;
(g)contracts for differences whose underlying subject matter consists wholly of interest rates or creditworthiness or both of those matters.”.
(3)In subsection (11) (assumption as to investments of other authorised unit trust which are to be regarded as qualifying investments) after “within paragraphs (a) to (c)” insert “ , (f) and (g) ”.
(4)After subsection (12G) insert—
“(12H)For the purposes of this section—
“contract for differences” has the same meaning as in paragraph 12 of Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002;
“derivative contract” means—
a contract which is a derivative contract within the meaning of that Schedule, or
a contract which is, in the accounting period in question, treated as if it were a derivative contract by virtue of paragraph 36 of that Schedule (contracts relating to holdings in unit trust schemes, open-ended investment companies and offshore funds);
“underlying subject matter” has the same meaning as in paragraph 11 of that Schedule.”.
8U.K.In section 501A (supplementary charge in respect of ring fence trades) in subsection (5) (computation of financing costs) for paragraph (c) (any trading profit or loss, under Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) (interest rate and currency contracts), in relation to debt finance) substitute—
“(c)any credit or debit falling to be brought into account under Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002 (derivative contracts) in relation to debt finance;”.
9U.K.In section 768B (change in ownership of investment company: deductions generally)—
(a)in subsection (10) (restriction of debits brought into account in respect of loan relationships) at the end insert “(including debits so brought into account by virtue of paragraph 14(3)of Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002)”, and
(b)in subsection (13) (modified application of section 768) after “its loan relationships” insert “ (or its derivative contracts by virtue of paragraph 14(3) of Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002) ”.
10U.K.In section 768C (deductions: asset transferred within group) in subsection (9) (restriction of debits to be brought into account) at the end insert “(including debits so brought into account by virtue of paragraph 14(3) of Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002)”.
11U.K.In section 798B (restriction of relief on certain interest and dividends: meaning of “financial expenditure”) in subsection (5) (meaning of “qualifying losses”) for paragraph (b) (losses brought into account for purposes of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994) substitute—
“(b)the amount (if any) by which debits brought into account in respect of a derivative contract for the purposes of Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002 (derivative contracts) exceed credits so brought into account;”.
12(1)Section 807A (disposals and acquisitions of company loan relationships with or without interest) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In subsection (2)(b)(ii) (foreign tax to be disregarded so far as attributable to qualifying payment within Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994 relating to a time when a company is not party to a contract)—
(a)for “relevant qualifying payment” substitute “ relevant payment ”, and
(b)for “the interest rate or currency contract concerned” substitute “ the derivative contract concerned ”.
(3)In subsection (7) (definitions) insert the following definition at the appropriate place—
““relevant payment” means a payment the amount of which falls to be determined (wholly or mainly) by applying to a notional principal amount specified in a derivative contract, for a period so specified, a rate the value of which at all times is the same as that of a rate of interest so specified;”.
(4)In that subsection, omit the definition of “relevant qualifying payment”.
13U.K.In section 834(1) (interpretation of the Corporation Tax Acts) insert the following definition at the appropriate place—
““derivative contract” has the same meaning as it has for the purposes of Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002;”.
F15514U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F155Sch. 27 para. 14 repealed (6.4.2005) by Income Tax (Trading and Other Income) Act 2005 (c. 5), s. 883(1), Sch. 3 (with Sch. 2)
15(1)Schedule 28AA (provision not at arm’s length) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In paragraph 8 (foreign exchange gains and losses and financial instruments) in sub-paragraph (1) (exceptions)—
(a)after “sub-paragraph (3)” insert “ and sub-paragraph (4) ”, and
(b)for paragraph (b) (which relates to Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994 (c. 9)) substitute—
“(b)Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002 (derivative contracts) in respect of exchange gains and losses (as defined in paragraph 54 of that Schedule),”.
(3)In that paragraph, after sub-paragraph (3) (which is inserted by Schedule 23 to this Act) insert—
“(4)Sub-paragraph (1) above shall not affect so much of paragraph 27 of Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002 (derivative contracts: exchange gains or losses where derivative contract not on arm’s length terms) as has effect by reference to whether profits or losses fall to be computed by virtue of this Schedule as if a company were not party to a derivative contract or as if the terms of the contract to which it is party were different.”.
16In section 226 (provisions of the Finance Act 1993 (c. 34) and Finance Act 1994 which are not to apply in the case of Lloyd’s underwriters) for subsection (3) (contracts and options in premium trust fund of corporate member not to be qualifying contracts for purposes of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994) substitute—
“(3)No relevant contract (within the meaning of Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002) forming part of a premium trust fund of a corporate member shall be a derivative contract.”.
17The Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) is amended as follows.
F15618U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F156Sch. 27 para. 18 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 52(3), Sch. 10 para. 11(2)(3) of the amending Act) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), Sch. 42 Pt. 2(6)
F15719U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F157Sch. 27 para. 19 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F15820U.K.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F158Sch. 27 para. 20 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
21U.K.Omit Schedule 12(meaning of debt contract or option).
22The Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) is amended as follows.
23(1)Schedule 22 (tonnage tax) is amended as follows.U.K.
(2)In paragraph 50 (income which, otherwise than under Schedule 22 to the Finance Act 2000, falls to be taken into account as trading income from trade consisting of tonnage tax activities) in sub-paragraph (2), for paragraph (c) substitute—
“(c)any credit falling to be brought into account under Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002 (derivative contracts).”.
(3)In paragraph 63 (ring-fencing of accounting periods where company is tonnage tax company: meaning of “finance costs”) in sub-paragraph (2), for paragraph (b) substitute—
“(b)any credit or debit falling to be brought into account under Schedule 26 to the Finance Act 2002 (derivative contracts) in relation to debt finance;”.
24The Finance Act 2002 is amended as follows.
25U.K.Section 78 (which amends the provision made by Schedule 5AA to the Taxes Act 1988 as regards corporation tax in relation to guaranteed returns on transactions involving futures and options, provision as regards which is made in Schedule 26 in relation to accounting periods beginning on or after 1st October 2002) shall cease to have effect.
26U.K.In Schedule 29 (taxation of intangible fixed assets) in paragraph 75 (which provides for the Schedule not to apply to financial assets) for sub-paragraph (3)(b) (financial assets to include qualifying contracts within Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994) substitute—
“(b)derivative contracts (see Part 2 of Schedule 26 to this Act),”.
Section 83
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C4Sch. 28 extended (retrospective to 30.9.2002) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 177(6)-(8)(11)
F1591. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F159Sch. 28 para. 1 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 544(2), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
2(1)This paragraph applies if the conditions in sub-paragraphs (2) and (3) are satisfied in relation to any contract of a company.
(2)The first condition is that the company was a party to a qualifying contract (within the meaning of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994) before its commencement day, but is not a party to it on that commencement day.
(3)The second condition is that, if the company had been a party to the contract on its commencement day, the contract would have been a derivative contract.
(4)To the extent that amounts have been brought into account in computing, in accordance with Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994, the profits or losses accruing to the company from the contract in an old period of the company, they shall not be brought into account again by the company as credits or debits given in respect of that contract for the first new period or any subsequent accounting period of the company by Schedule 26.
[F160(4A)In relation to a subsequent accounting period ending on or after 1 April 2009, the reference in sub-paragraph (4) to Schedule 26 is to be read as a reference to Part 7 of the Corporation Tax Act 2009.]
Textual Amendments
F160Sch. 28 para. 2(4A) inserted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 544(3) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
F1613. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F161Sch. 28 para. 3 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 544(4), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
4(1)This paragraph applies if the conditions in sub-paragraphs (2) to (4) are satisfied in relation to any contract of a company.
(2)The first condition is that the company is a party to the contract immediately before and on its commencement day.
(3)The second condition is that the contract—
(a)was not a qualifying contract (within the meaning of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994) immediately before the company’s commencement day, but
(b)as from that day is a derivative contract.
(4)The third condition is that the contract was, immediately before the company’s commencement day, a chargeable asset.
(5)Where this paragraph applies, the company shall, when it ceases to be a party to the contract, bring into account, for the accounting period in which it ceases to be a party to the contract, the amount of any chargeable gain or allowable loss which would have been treated as accruing to the company on the assumption—
(a)that it had made a disposal of the asset immediately before its commencement day, and
(b)that the disposal had been for a consideration equal to the value (if any) given to the contract in the accounts of the company at the end of the company’s accounting period immediately before its first new period.
(6)Sub-paragraph (5) has effect subject to sub-paragraph (7).
(7)The company may elect that a debit representing the amount of any allowable loss, which under sub-paragraph (5) is to be brought into account for the accounting period in which it ceases to be a party to the contract, shall be brought into account for that accounting period as if it were a non-trading debit falling to be brought into account for the purposes of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) in respect of a loan relationship of the company.
[F162(7A)In relation to an accounting period ending on or after 1 April 2009, the reference in sub-paragraph (7) to Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 is to be read as a reference to Part 5 of the Corporation Tax Act 2009.]
(8)An election under sub-paragraph (7) may only be made within the period of two years following the end of the accounting period in which the company ceases to be a party to the contract.
(9)For the purposes of this paragraph an asset is a chargeable asset if any gain accruing on the disposal of the asset by the company would be a chargeable gain for the purposes of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) (and includes any obligations under futures contracts which, by virtue of section 143 of that Act, are regarded as assets to the disposal of which that Act applies).
(10)This paragraph has effect subject to paragraph 5.
Textual Amendments
F162Sch. 28 para. 4(7A) inserted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 544(5) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
5(1)This paragraph applies if the conditions in sub-paragraphs (2) to (4) are satisfied in relation to any contract of a company.
(2)The first condition is that the company is a party to the contract immediately before and on its commencement day.
(3)The second condition is that the contract—
(a)was not a qualifying contract (within the meaning of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994 (c. 9)) immediately before the company’s commencement day, but
(b)as from that day would, but for an election under sub-paragraph (5) of this paragraph, be a derivative contract to which paragraph 7 of Schedule 26 (contracts designed to secure guaranteed amount) applies.
(4)The third condition is that the contract was, immediately before the company’s commencement day, a chargeable asset.
(5)Where this paragraph applies the company may elect that its contract shall be treated for the purposes of the Corporation Tax Acts as if it were—
(a)a creditor relationship of the company which is a zero coupon bond (within the meaning of paragraph 48 of Schedule 26), and
(b)an option of the company whose underlying subject matter is the same as the underlying subject matter of the contract to which this paragraph applies;
and sub-paragraphs (4) to (6) of that paragraph shall apply to a creditor relationship and an option arising under this sub-paragraph as they apply to a creditor relationship and an option arising under paragraph 48(2) of Schedule 26.
(6)An election under sub-paragraph (5) in relation to a contract—
(a)may only be made within the period of two years following the end of the company’s first new period;
(b)has effect for the company’s first new period and all subsequent accounting periods of the company; and
(c)is irrevocable.
(7)Where an election under sub-paragraph (5) has been made by a company in relation to a contract, the company shall, when it ceases to be a party to the contract, bring into account, for the accounting period in which it ceases to be a party to the contract, the amount of any chargeable gain or allowable loss which would have been treated as accruing to the company on the assumption—
(a)that it had made a disposal of the asset immediately before its commencement day, and
(b)that the disposal had been for a consideration equal to the value (if any) given to the contract in the accounts of the company at the end of the company’s accounting period immediately before its first new period.
(8)Sub-paragraph (7) has effect subject to sub-paragraph (9).
(9)The company may elect that a debit representing the amount of any allowable loss, which under sub-paragraph (7) is to be brought into account for the accounting period in which it ceases to be a party to the contract, shall be brought into account for that accounting period as if it were a non-trading debit falling to be brought into account for the purposes of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) in respect of a loan relationship of the company.
[F163(9A)In relation to an accounting period ending on or after 1 April 2009, the reference in sub-paragraph (9) to Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 is to be read as a reference to Part 5 of the Corporation Tax Act 2009.]
(10)An election under sub-paragraph (9) may only be made within the period of two years following the end of the accounting period in which the company ceases to be a party to the contract.
(11)For the purposes of this paragraph references to an asset being a chargeable asset shall be construed in accordance with paragraph 4(9).
(12)In this paragraph “option” and “underlying subject matter” have the same meaning as in Schedule 26.
Textual Amendments
F163Sch. 28 para. 5(9A) inserted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 544(6) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
6(1)This paragraph applies if the conditions in sub-paragraphs (2) to (5) are satisfied in relation to any contract of a company.
(2)The first condition is that the company is a party to the contract immediately before and on its commencement day.
(3)The second condition is that the contract—
(a)was not a qualifying contract (within the meaning of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994 (c. 9)) immediately before the company’s commencement day, but
(b)as from that day is a derivative contract.
(4)The third condition is that the contract was, immediately before the company’s commencement day, a transaction to which Schedule 5AA to the Taxes Act 1988 applied.
(5)The fourth condition is that, on or after the company’s commencement day, a relevant event occurs.
(6)For the purposes of this paragraph a relevant event is an event which would, if Schedule 5AA to the Taxes Act 1988 had continued to apply to the contract for the purposes of corporation tax, have given rise to an amount of profits falling to be charged under that Schedule.
(7)A credit representing that amount of profits (“a relevant credit”) shall be brought into account by virtue of paragraph 14(3) of Schedule 26 for the accounting period in which the relevant event occurs as if it were a non-trading credit falling to be brought into account for the purposes of Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 in respect of a loan relationship of the company.
(8)The amount of the relevant credit is the sum of—
(a)the amount of profits which would have been chargeable under Schedule 5AA to the Taxes Act 1988 if it had continued to apply to the contract, and
(b)the amount of any debits given by Schedule 26 in respect of the contract for the first new period and any subsequent accounting period ending with the accounting period in which the relevant event occurred,
less the amount of any credits given by Schedule 26 in respect of the contract for those accounting periods.
[F164(8A)In relation to an accounting period ending on or after 1 April 2009—
(a)the reference in sub-paragraph (7) to paragraph 14(3) of Schedule 26 is to be read as a reference to section 574 of the Corporation Tax Act 2009,
(b)the reference in that sub-paragraph to Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 is to be read as a reference to Part 5 of the Corporation Tax Act 2009, and
(c)the references in sub-paragraph (8) to Schedule 26 are to be read as references to Part 7 of the Corporation Tax Act 2009.]
Textual Amendments
F164Sch. 28 para. 6(8A) inserted (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 544(7) (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
7For the purposes of this Schedule—
(a)a company’s commencement day is the first day of its first accounting period to begin on or after 1st October 2002,
(b)a company’s first new period is its first accounting period to begin on or after that date, and
(c)an old period of the company is any accounting period of the company ending before the first day of its first new period.
Section 84(1)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F165Sch. 29 repealed (with effect in accordance with s. 1329(1) of the amending Act) by Corporation Tax Act 2009 (c. 4), s. 1329(1), Sch. 1 para. 545, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2 Pts. 1, 2)
Section 84(2)
1(1)For sections 337 and 337A of the Taxes Act 1988 (corporation tax: general provisions about taxation of income) substitute—
(1)Where a company begins or ceases—
(a)to carry on a trade, or
(b)to be within the charge to corporation tax in respect of a trade,
the company’s income shall be computed as if that were the commencement or, as the case may be, the discontinuance of the trade, whether or not the trade is in fact commenced or discontinued.
(2)Subsection (1) applies to a Schedule A business or overseas property business as it applies to a trade.
(1)For the purposes of corporation tax, subject to any provision of the Corporation Tax Acts expressly authorising a deduction—
(a)a company’s profits shall be computed without any deduction in respect of dividends or other distributions, and
(b)a company’s income from any source shall be computed without any deduction in respect of charges on income.
(2)In computing a company’s income from any source for the purposes of corporation tax—
(a)no deduction shall be made in respect of interest except in accordance with Chapter 2 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1996 (loan relationships); and
(b)no deduction shall be made in respect of losses from intangible fixed assets within Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 except in accordance with that Schedule.”.
(2)For section 338 of the Taxes Act 1988 (corporation tax: charges on income) substitute—
(1)Charges on income are allowed as deductions from a company’s total profits in computing the corporation tax chargeable for an accounting period.
(2)They are deducted from the company’s total profits for the period as reduced by any other relief from tax other than group relief.
(3)The amount of the deduction is limited to the amount that reduces the company’s total profits for the period to nil.
(4)Except as otherwise provided, a deduction is allowed only in respect of payments made by the company in the accounting period concerned.
(5)The above provisions are subject to any express exceptions in the Corporation Tax Acts.
(1)This section defines what payments or other amounts are “charges on income” for the purposes of corporation tax.
This section has effect subject to any express exceptions in the Corporation Tax Acts.
(2)Subject to the following provisions of this section, the following (and only the following) are charges on income—
(a)annuities or other annual payments that meet the conditions specified in section 338B;
(b)qualifying donations within the meaning of section 339 (qualifying donations to charity);
(c)amounts allowed as charges on income under section 587B(2)(a)(ii) (gifts of shares etc to charity).
(3)No payment that is deductible in computing profits or any description of profits for the purposes of corporation tax shall be treated as a charge on income.
(4)No payment shall be treated as a charge on income if (without being so deductible) it is—
(a)an annuity payable by an insurance company, or
(b)an annuity or other annual payment payable by a company wholly or partly in satisfaction of any claim under an insurance policy in relation to which the company is the insurer.
In paragraph (a) “insurance company” has the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 12.
(1)An annuity or other annual payment is a charge on income if—
(a)the requirements specified in subsection (2) are met, and
(b)it is not excluded from being a charge on income for the purposes of corporation tax—
(i)by any of the following provisions of this section, or
(ii)by any other provision of the Corporation Tax Acts.
(2)The requirements are that the payment—
(a)is made under a liability incurred for a valuable and sufficient consideration,
(b)is not charged to capital,
(c)is ultimately borne by the company, and
(d)in the case of a company not resident in the United Kingdom, is incurred wholly and exclusively for the purposes of a trade which is or is to be carried on by it in the United Kingdom through a branch or agency.
(3)An annuity or other annual payment made to a person not resident in the United Kingdom shall be treated as a charge on income only if the following conditions are met.
(4)The conditions are that the company making the payment is resident in the United Kingdom and that either—
(a)the company deducts tax from the payment in accordance with section 349, and accounts under Schedule 16 for the tax so deducted, or
(b)the person beneficially entitled to the income in respect of which the payment is made is a company that is not resident in the United Kingdom but which carries on a trade in the United Kingdom through a branch or agency and the payment falls to be brought into account in computing the chargeable profits (within the meaning given by section 11(2) of that company, or
(c)the payment is one payable out of income brought into charge to tax under Case V of Schedule D.
(5)An annuity or other annual payment is not a charge on income if—
(a)it is payable in respect of the company’s loan relationships, or
(b)it is a royalty to which Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 applies (intangible fixed assets).
(6)Nothing in this section prevents an annuity or other annual payment from being a charge on income if it is a qualifying donation (within the meaning of section 339).”.
(3)In section 214(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 (chargeable payments connected with exempt distributions), in paragraph (c) (payments not to be treated as distributions for purposes of certain provisions) for “sections 337(2) and 338(2)(a)" substitute “ section 337A(1) ”.
(4)In section 834(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 (interpretation of the Corporation Tax Acts), in the definition of “charges on income" for “338" substitute “ 338A ”.
F166(5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F166Sch. 30 para. 1(5) repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
2(1)In section 403 of the Taxes Act 1988 (amounts that may be surrendered by way of group relief)—
(a)in subsection (1)(b) (amounts that may be surrendered if available for group relief) for “or management expenses which are" substitute “ , management expenses or a non-trading loss on intangible fixed assets ”;
(b)in subsection (3), in the first sentence (meaning of availability for group relief), for “and management expenses" substitute “ management expenses and a non-trading loss on intangible fixed assets ”;
(c)in subsection (3), in the second sentence (order in which amounts treated as used), for “and finally management expenses" substitute “ , management expenses and finally a non-trading loss on intangible fixed assets ”.
(2)In section 403ZD of the Taxes Act 1988 (further provisions as to amounts available for group relief), after subsection (5) insert—
“(6)A non-trading loss on intangible fixed assets means a non-trading loss on intangible fixed assets, within the meaning of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002, for the surrender period.
It does not include so much of any such loss as is attributable to an amount being carried forward under paragraph 35(3) of that Schedule (amounts carried forward from earlier periods).”.
3In section 505(1) of the Taxes Act 1988 (charities: exemptions), in paragraph (c) (income charged under Schedule D) after sub-paragraph (iib) insert—
“(iic)from tax under Case VI of Schedule D in respect of non-trading gains on intangible fixed assets under Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002, and”.
4(1)Chapter 6 of Part 17 of the Taxes Act 1988 (tax avoidance: miscellaneous) is amended as follows.
(2)In section 768C, after subsection (12) add—
“(13)This section applies in relation to an asset to which Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 applies (intangible fixed assets), with the following adaptations—
(a)for the reference to section 171(1) of the 1992 Act substitute a reference to paragraph 55 of that Schedule;
(b)for any reference to a chargeable gain under that Act substitute a reference to a chargeable realisation gain within the meaning of that Schedule that is a credit within paragraph 34(1)(a) of that Schedule (non-trading credits);
(c)for any reference to a disposal of the asset substitute a reference to its realisation within the meaning of that Schedule;
(d)for the reference to the relevant provisions of the 1992 Act substitute a reference to Part 6 of that Schedule.”.
(3)After section 768D insert—
(1)Where there is a change in the ownership of an investment company and either—
(a)paragraph (a), (b) or (c) of section 768B(1) applies, or
(b)section 768C applies,
the following provisions have effect to prevent relief being given under paragraph 35 of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 by setting a non-trading loss on intangible fixed assets incurred by the company before the change of ownership against profits arising after the change.
(2)The accounting period in which the change of ownership occurs is treated for that purpose as two separate accounting periods, the first ending with the change and the second consisting of the remainder of the period.
(3)The profits or losses of the period in which the change occurs are apportioned to those two periods—
(a)where paragraph (a), (b) or (c) of section 768B(1) applies, in accordance with Parts 2 and 3 of Schedule 28A, or
(b)where section 768C applies, in accordance with Parts 5 and 6 of that Schedule,
unless in any case the specified method of apportionment would work unjustly or unreasonably in which case such other method shall be used as appears just and reasonable.
(4)Relief under paragraph 35 of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 against total profits of the same accounting period is available only in relation to each of those periods considered separately.
(5)A loss made in any accounting period beginning before the change of ownership may not be set off under paragraph 35(3) of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 against—
(a)in a case where paragraph (a), (b) or (c) of section 768B(1) applies, profits of an accounting period ending after the change of ownership;
(b)in a case where section 768C applies, so much of those profits as represents the relevant gain within the meaning of that section.
(6)Subsections (8) and (9) of section 768 (time limits for assessment; information powers) apply for the purposes of this section as they apply for the purposes of that section.
(7)In this section “investment company” has the same meaning as in Part 4.”.
(4)In paragraph 6 of Schedule 28A to the Taxes Act 1988 (amounts in issue for purposes of section 768B), after paragraph (dd) insert—
“(de)the amount of any non-trading credits or debits in respect of intangible fixed assets that fall to be brought into account for that period under paragraph 34 of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002;
(df)the amount of any non-trading loss on intangible fixed assets carried forward to that accounting period under paragraph 35(3) of that Schedule;”.
(5)In paragraph 7(1) of that Schedule (apportionment for purposes of section 768B), after paragraph (f) insert—
“(g)in the case of any such credit or debit as is mentioned in paragraph 6(de), by apportioning to each accounting period the credits or debits that would fall to be brought into account in that period if it were a period of account for which accounts were drawn up in accordance with generally accepted accounting practice;
(h)in the case of any such loss as is mentioned in paragraph 6(df) above, by apportioning the whole amount of the loss to the first part of the accounting period being divided.”.
(6)In paragraph 13(1) of that Schedule (amounts in issue for purposes of section 768C), after paragraph (ed) insert—
“(ee)the amount of any non-trading credits or debits in respect of intangible fixed assets that fall to be brought into account for that period under paragraph 34 of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002;
(ef)the amount of any non-trading loss on intangible fixed assets carried forward to that accounting period under paragraph 35(3) of that Schedule;”.
(7)In paragraph 16(1) of that Schedule (apportionment for purposes of section 768C), after paragraph (f) insert—
“(g)in the case of any such credit or debit as is mentioned in paragraph 13(ee), by apportioning to each accounting period the credits or debits that would fall to be brought into account in that period if it were a period of account for which accounts were drawn up in accordance with generally accepted accounting practice;
(h)in the case of any such loss as is mentioned in paragraph 13(ef), by apportioning the whole amount of the loss to the first part of the accounting period being divided.”.
5(1)Part 18 of the Taxes Act 1988 (double taxation relief) is amended as follows.
(2)In section 795 (computation of income subject to foreign tax), in subsection (4) (application of that section notwithstanding certain other provisions) after “notwithstanding anything in" insert “ —(a) ” and at the end insert— “, or
(b)paragraph 1(3) of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 (matters to be brought into account in respect of intangible fixed assets only under that Schedule).”.
(3)In the heading to section 797A (foreign tax on items giving rise to a non-trading credit), at the end add “: loan relationships".
(4)After that section insert—
(1)This section applies for the purposes of any arrangements where, in the case of a company—
(a)a non-trading credit relating to an item is brought into account for the purposes of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 (intangible fixed assets) for an accounting period (“the applicable accounting period”), and
(b)there is in respect of that item an amount of foreign tax for which, under the arrangements, credit is allowable against United Kingdom tax computed by reference to that item.
(2)It shall be assumed that tax chargeable under Case VI of Schedule D on the profits and gains arising for the applicable accounting period from the company’s intangible fixed assets falls to be computed on the actual amount of its non-trading credits for that period, and without any deduction in respect of non-trading debits.
(3)Section 797(3) shall have effect as if—
(a)there were for the applicable accounting period an amount equal to the adjusted amount of the non-trading debits falling to be brought into account by being set against profits of the company for that period of any description, and
(b)different parts of that amount might be set against different profits.
(4)For this purpose the adjusted amount of a company’s non-trading debits for an accounting period is given by:
where—
Total Debits is the aggregate amount of the company’s non-trading debits for that accounting period under Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 (intangible fixed assets), and
Amount Carried Forward is the amount (if any) carried forward to the next accounting period of the company under paragraph 35(3) of that Schedule (carry-forward of non-trading loss in respect of which no claim is made for it to be set against total profits of current period).”.
(5)In section 811 (deduction for foreign tax where no credit available), in subsection (3) (application of that section notwithstanding certain other provisions) after “notwithstanding anything in" insert “ —(a) ” and at the end insert— “, or
(b)paragraph 1(3) of Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002 (matters to be brought into account in respect of intangible fixed assets only under that Schedule).”.
6After section 33 of the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (provisions supplementary to sections 30 to 32) insert—
(1)Sections 30 to 33 have effect in relation to a chargeable intangible asset subject to the following modifications.
In this section “chargeable intangible asset” has the same meaning as in Schedule 29 to the Finance Act 2002.
(2)Any reference in those sections—
(a)to a disposal or part disposal of the asset shall be read as a reference to its realisation or part realisation within the meaning of that Schedule (see paragraph 19 of that Schedule);
(b)to an disposal of the asset under section 171(1) shall be read as a reference to its transfer under paragraph 55 of that Schedule (transfers within a group);
(c)to a disposal of the asset under section 179 shall be read as a reference to its realisation under paragraph 58 or 60 of that Schedule (degrouping).
(3)In section 31(6), paragraph (c) shall not apply to a revaluation where the profit on the revaluation is wholly taken into account as a credit under that Schedule (see paragraph 15 of that Schedule).
(4)None of the conditions in section 31(9) shall be treated as satisfied if the asset with enhanced value is a chargeable intangible asset within the meaning of that Schedule.
(5)The reference in section 32(2)(b) to the cost of the underlying asset shall be read, in the case of a chargeable intangible asset, as a reference to the capitalised value of the asset recognised for accounting purposes.”.
Section 85
The following Schedule is inserted after Schedule 7AC to the Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12)—
1This Schedule applies where the assets of the long-term insurance fund of an insurance company (“the company”) include assets held by the company as a limited partner in a venture capital investment partnership (“the partnership”).
2(1)A “venture capital investment partnership” means a partnership in relation to which the following conditions are met.
(2)The first condition is that the sole or main purpose of the partnership is to invest in unquoted shares or securities.
This condition shall not be regarded as met unless it appears from—
the agreement constituting the partnership, or
any prospectus issued to prospective partners,
that that is the sole or main purpose of the partnership.
(3)The second condition is that the partnership does not carry on a trade.
(4)The third condition is that not less than 90% of the book value of the partnership’s investments is attributable to investments that are either—
(a)shares or securities that were unquoted at the time of their acquisition by the partnership, or
(b)shares that were quoted at the time of their acquisition by the partnership but which it was reasonable to believe would cease to be quoted within the next twelve months.
(5)For the purposes of the third condition—
(a)the following shall be disregarded—
(i)any holding of cash, including cash deposited in a bank account or similar account but not cash acquired wholly or partly for the purpose of realising a gain on its disposal;
(ii)any holding of quoted shares or securities acquired by the partnership in exchange for unquoted shares or securities;
(b)whether the 90% test is met shall be determined by reference to the values shown in the partnership’s accounts at the end of a period of account of the partnership.
(6)Where a partnership ceases to meet the above conditions, the company shall be treated as if the partnership had continued to be a venture capital investment partnership until the end of the period of account of the partnership during which it ceased to meet the conditions.
(7)A partnership that ceases to meet those conditions cannot qualify again as a venture capital investment partnership.
For this purpose a partnership is treated as the same partnership notwithstanding a change in membership if any person who was a member before the change remains a member.
3(1)Where this Schedule applies section 59 (partnerships) does not have effect to make the company chargeable on its share of gains accruing on each disposal of relevant assets of the partnership.
(2)Instead—
(a)the company’s interest in relevant assets of the partnership is treated as a single asset (“the single asset”) acquired by the company when it became a member of the partnership, and
(b)the following provisions of this Schedule have effect.
(3)For the purposes of this Schedule the “relevant assets” of the partnership are the shares and securities held by the partnership, other than qualifying corporate bonds.
(4)Nothing in this Schedule shall be read—
(a)as affecting the operation of section 59 in relation to partners who are not insurance companies carrying on long-term business or are not limited partners, or
(b)as imposing any liability on the partnership as such.
4(1)The company is treated as having given, wholly and exclusively for the acquisition of the single asset, consideration equal to the amount of capital contributed by it on becoming a member of the partnership.
(2)Any further amounts of capital contributed by it to the partnership are treated on a disposal of the single asset as expenditure incurred wholly and exclusively on the asset for the purpose of enhancing its value and reflected in its state or nature at the time of the disposal.
(3)Where the investments of the partnership include qualifying corporate bonds, the amount to be taken into account under sub-paragraph (1) or (2) is proportionately reduced.
(4)The reduction is made by applying to that amount the fraction:
where—
A is the book value of all shares and securities held by the partnership at the end of the period of account of the partnership in which the amount of capital in question is fully invested by the partnership, and
B is the book value of all qualifying corporate bonds held by the partnership at the end of that period of account.
(5)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (4) the “book value” means the value shown in the partnership’s accounts at the end of the period of account.
5(1)There is a disposal of the single asset on each occasion on which the company receives a distribution from the partnership that does not consist entirely of income or the proceeds of sale or redemption of assets that are not relevant assets.
(2)The disposal is taken to be for a consideration equal to the amount of the distribution or of so much of it as does not consist of income or the proceeds of sale or redemption of assets that are not relevant assets.
(3)Where—
(a)the partnership disposes of relevant assets on which a chargeable gain or allowable loss would accrue if they were held by the company alone, and
(b)no distribution of the proceeds of the disposal is made within twelve months of the disposal,
the company is treated as having received its share of the proceeds as a distribution at the end of the period of account of the partnership following that in which the disposal took place, or at the end of the period of six months after the date of the disposal, whichever is the later.
(4)The operation of sub-paragraph (3) is not affected by the partnership having ceased to be a venture capital investment partnership before the time at which the distribution is treated as received by the company.
(5)Where sub-paragraph (3) applies, any subsequent actual distribution of the proceeds is disregarded.
6(1)For the purposes of section 42 (apportionment of cost etc in case of part disposal) the market value of the property remaining undisposed of on a part disposal of the single asset shall be determined as follows.
(2)If there is no further disposal of that asset in the period of account in which the part disposal in question takes place, the market value of the property remaining undisposed of shall be taken to be equal to the company’s share of the book value of the relevant assets of the partnership as shown in the partnership’s accounts at the end of that period of account.
(3)If there is a further disposal of that asset in the period of account in which the part disposal in question takes place, or more than one, the market value of the property remaining undisposed of shall be taken to be equal to the sum of—
(a)the amount or value of the consideration on the further disposal or, as the case may be, the total amount or value of the consideration on the further disposals, and
(b)the amount (if any) of the company’s share of the book value of the relevant assets of the partnership as shown in the partnership’s accounts at the end of that period of account.
7(1)Nothing in this Schedule shall be read as affecting the operation of Chapter 5 of Part 17 of the Taxes Act (offshore funds).
(2)Where an offshore income gain accrues to the company under that Chapter from the disposal of any relevant asset of the partnership, the amount of any distribution received or treated as received by the company from the partnership that represents the whole or part of the proceeds of disposal of that asset is treated for the purposes of this Schedule as reduced by the amount of the whole or a corresponding part of the offshore income gain.
8No claim may be made in respect of the single asset under section 24(2) (assets that have become of negligible value).
9(1)For the purposes of paragraph 2 (meaning of “venture capital investment partnership") an investment by way of capital contribution to another venture capital investment partnership shall be treated as an investment in unquoted shares or securities.
(2)The Treasury may by regulations make provision, in place of but corresponding to that made by paragraphs 3 to 8, in relation to gains accruing on a disposal of relevant assets by such a partnership.
(3)The regulations may make provision for any period of account to which, in accordance with paragraphs 11 to 13, this Schedule applies.
10(1)In this Schedule—
“insurance company”, “long-term business” and “long-term insurance fund” have the same meaning as in Chapter 1 of Part 12 of the Taxes Act (see section 431(2) of that Act);
“limited partner” means—
a person carrying on a business as a limited partner in a partnership registered under the Limited Partnership Act 1907, or
a person carrying on a business jointly with others who, under the law of a country or territory outside the United Kingdom, is not entitled to take part in the management of the business and is not liable beyond a certain limit for debts or obligations incurred for the purposes of the business;
“relevant assets” has the meaning given by paragraph 3(3);
“securities” has the same meaning as in section 132 and also includes any debentures;
“unquoted” and “quoted”, in relation to shares or securities, refer to listing on a recognised stock exchange.
(2)References in this Schedule to the partnership’s accounts are to accounts drawn up in accordance with generally accepted accounting practice.
If no such accounts are drawn up, the references to the treatment of any matter, or the amounts shown, in the accounts of the partnership are to what would have appeared if accounts had been drawn up in accordance with generally accepted accounting practice.
(3)References in this Schedule to capital contributed to a limited partnership include amounts purporting to be provided by way of loan if—
(a)the loan carries no interest,
(b)all the limited partners are required to make such loans, and
(c)the loans are accounted for as partners’ capital, or partners’ equity, in the accounts of the partnership.
(4)For the purposes of this Schedule the assets of—
(a)a Scottish partnership, or
(b)a partnership under the law of any other country or territory under which assets of a partnership are regarded as held by or on behalf of the partnership as such,
shall be treated as held by the members of the partnership in the proportions in which they are entitled to share in the profits of the partnership.
References in this Schedule to the company’s interest in, or share of, the partnership’s assets shall be construed accordingly.
11(1)Subject to paragraph 12 (election to remain outside Schedule), this Schedule applies—
(a)to periods of account of the partnership beginning on or after 1st January 2002, and
(b)to a period of account of the partnership beginning before that date and ending on or after it, unless the company elects that it shall not do so.
(2)Where the company became a member of the partnership before the beginning of the first period of account of the partnership to which this Schedule applies, the cost of the single asset at the beginning of that period of account shall be taken to be equal to the total of the relevant indexed base costs.
(3)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2)—
(a)the “indexed base cost” means—
(i)in relation to a holding that by virtue of section 104 is to be treated as a single asset, what would be the indexed pool of expenditure within the meaning of section 110 if the holding were disposed of, and
(ii)in relation to any other asset, the amount of expenditure together with the indexation allowance that would be fall to be deducted if the asset were disposed of; and
(b)the “relevant indexed base costs” means the indexed base costs that would be taken into account in computing in accordance with section 59 the gain or loss of the company if all the shares and securities (other than qualifying corporate bonds) held by the partnership were disposed of on the last day of the company’s accounting period immediately preceding its first accounting period beginning on or after 1st January 2002.
(4)No account shall be taken under this Schedule of a distribution by the partnership in a period of account to which this Schedule applies to the extent that it represents a chargeable gain accruing in an earlier period to which this Schedule does not apply.
12If the company—
(a)became a member of the partnership before the beginning of the first period of account of the partnership to which this Schedule would otherwise apply, or
(b)made its first contribution of capital to the partnership before 17th April 2002,
it may elect that the provisions of this Schedule shall not apply to it in relation to that partnership.
13Any election under paragraph 11 or 12 must be made—
(a)by notice to an officer of the Board,
(b)not later than the end of the period of two years after the end of the company’s first accounting period beginning on or after 1st January 2002.”.
Section 86
1Chapter 3 of Part 2 of the Finance Act 1993 (c. 34) (Lloyd’s underwriters, etc) is amended as follows.
2U.K.In section 178(stop loss and quota share insurance), in subsection (1) (deductions), for paragraph (c) substitute—
“(c)where an amount is payable by him under a quota share contract—
(i)so much of that amount as exceeds the amount of transferred losses that are declared on or before the date the contract takes effect (“the declared amount”), or
(ii)if the contract does not take effect, the amount so payable under the contract.”.
3U.K.After subsection (3) of that section insert—
“(3A)Where the amount payable by a member under a quota share contract is less than the declared amount, the difference between the two amounts shall be treated as a trading receipt in computing the profits arising from the member’s underwriting business in the year of assessment which corresponds to the underwriting year in which the contract takes effect.
(3B)Where a member has entered a quota share contract, any amount paid by him to cover a cash call in respect of transferred losses that are not declared at the time the contract takes effect shall be treated—
(a)for the purposes of subsection (1)(c)(i) and (3A) above, as an amount payable under the contract, and
(b)for the purposes of section 172, as a payment made at the time the contract takes effect.”.
4U.K.For subsection (4) of that section substitute—
“(4)For the purposes of this section—
“cash call” has the same meaning as in Part 1 of Schedule 20 to this Act;
“quota share contract” means any contract between a member and another person which—
is made in accordance with the rules or practice of Lloyd’s, and
provides for that other person to take over any rights and liabilities of the member under any of the syndicates of which he is a member;
and where the taking over of a member’s rights and liabilities is conditional upon the occurrence of any event, the contract does not take effect until that event occurs; and
“transferred loss”, in relation to such a contract, means a loss for which that other person takes over liability under the contract (disregarding, in the case of a loss that has been declared at the time it is taken over, any part of it in respect of which the member has paid a cash call before that time).”.
5U.K.In section 184(1) (interpretation), in the definition of “stop-loss insurance", after “business" insert “ , except insurance taken out by entering a quota share contract (within the meaning of section 178 above) ”.
6Chapter 5 of Part 4 of the Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) (Lloyd’s underwriters: corporations etc) is amended as follows.
7U.K.In section 225 (stop loss and quota share insurance), in subsection (1) (deductions), for paragraph (b) substitute—
“b)where an amount is payable by it under a quota share contract—
(i)so much of that amount as exceeds the amount of transferred losses that are declared on or before the date the contract takes effect (“the declared amount”), or
(ii)if the contract does not take effect, the amount so payable under the contract.”.
8U.K.After subsection (3) of that section insert—
“(3A)Where the amount payable by a corporate member under a quota share contract is less than the declared amount—
(a)if the underwriting year in which the contract takes effect falls within a single accounting period, the difference between the two amounts (“the surplus”) shall be treated as a trading receipt in computing the profits arising from the member’s underwriting business for that period, and
(b)if that underwriting year falls within two or more accounting periods, the apportioned part of the surplus shall be treated as a trading receipt in computing the profits arising from the member’s underwriting business for each of those periods.
(3B)Where a corporate member has entered a quota share contract, any amount paid by it to cover a cash call in respect of transferred losses that are not declared at the time the contract takes effect shall be treated, for the purposes of subsections (1)(b)(i) and (3A) above, as an amount payable under the contract at that time.”.
9U.K.For subsection (4) of that section substitute—
“(4)In this section—
“apportioned part”, in relation to any insurance money or other amount, means a part apportioned under section 72 of the Taxes Act 1988;
“cash call” means a request for funds which, in pursuance of a contract made in accordance with the rules and practices of Lloyd’s, is made to a corporate member by the agent of a syndicate of which it is a member;
“quota share contract” means any contract between a corporate member and another person which—
is made in accordance with the rules or practice of Lloyd’s; and
provides for that other person to take over any rights and liabilities of the member under any of the syndicates of which it is a member;
and where the taking over of a member’s rights and liabilities is conditional upon the occurrence of any event, the contract does not take effect until that event occurs; and
“transferred loss”, in relation to such a contract, means a loss for which that other person takes over liability under the contract (disregarding, in the case of a loss that has been declared at the time it is taken over, any part of it in respect of which the member has paid a cash call before that time).”.
10U.K.In section 230(1) (interpretation), in the definition of “stop-loss insurance", after “business" insert “ , except insurance taken out by entering a quota share contract (within the meaning of section 225 above) ”.
Section 109
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Textual Amendments
F167Sch. 33 repealed (6.4.2007) by Income Tax Act 2007 (c. 3), s. 1034(1), Sch. 1 para. 423, Sch. 3 Pt. 1 (with Sch. 2)
Section 111
1(1)The provisions of this Schedule supplement section 111 (withdrawal of group relief).
(2)Expressions used in this Schedule that are defined for the purposes of that section have the same meaning in this Schedule.
2(1)Section 111 does not apply if the transferee company ceases to be a member of the same group as the transferor company by reason of the latter company leaving the group.
(2)The transferor company is regarded as leaving the group if the companies cease to be members of the same group by reason of a transaction relating to shares in—
(a)the transferor company, or
(b)another company that as a result of the transaction ceases to be a member of the same group as the transferee company.
3(1)Section 111 does not apply if the transferee company ceases to be a member of the same group as the transferor company by reason of anything done for the purposes of, or in the course of, winding up the transferor company or another company that is above the transferor company in the group structure.
(2)For the purposes of this paragraph a company is “above” the transferor company in the group structure if it is the parent (within the meaning of the relevant group relief provision)—
(a)of the transferor company, or
(b)of another company that is above the transferor company in the group structure.
4(1)Section 111 does not apply if—
(a)the transferee company ceases to be a member of the same group as the transferor company as a result of an acquisition of shares by another company (“the parent company”) in relation to which acquisition relief applies, and
(b)the transferee company is immediately after that acquisition a member of the same group as the parent company (“the new group”).
(2)For this purpose—
(a)“acquisition relief” means relief under section 75 of the Finance Act 1986 (c. 41); and
(b)references to an acquisition in relation to which such relief applies are to an acquisition such that an instrument effecting the transfer of the shares is exempt from stamp duty by virtue of that provision.
(3)But if before the end of the period of two years beginning with the date on which the relevant instrument was executed—
(a)the transferee company ceases to be a member of the new group, and
(b)at the time when [F168the transferee company ceases] to be a member of the new group [F169it or a relevant associated company (as defined in sub-paragraph (4) below) holds] an estate or interest in land that—
(i)was transferred [F170to the transferee company] by the relevant instrument, or
(ii)is derived from an estate or interest that was so transferred,
[F171and that has not subsequently been transferred at market value by a duly stamped instrument on which ad valorem duty was paid and in respect of which group relief was not claimed],
section 111 and the provisions of this Schedule apply [F172as if the transferee had then ceased to be a member of the same group as the transferor company and had then held the estate or interest referred to in paragraph (b).]
[F173(4)In sub-paragraph (3)(b) “relevant associated company”, in relation to the transferee company, means a company that is in the same group as the transferee company immediately before the transferee company ceases to be a member of the new group and which ceases to be a member of the new group in consequence of the transferee company so ceasing.]
Textual Amendments
F168Words in Sch. 34 para. 4(3)(b) substituted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 126(6)(a)(i)(11) (with s. 126(9)(10))
F169Words in Sch. 34 para. 4(3)(b) substituted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 126(6)(a)(ii)(11) (with s. 126(9)(10))
F170Words in Sch. 34 para. 4(3)(b)(i) substituted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 126(6)(b)(11) (with s. 126(9)(10))
F171Words in Sch. 34 para. 4(3)(b) substituted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 126(6)(c)(11) (with s. 126(9)(10))
5(1)If any duty payable under section 111 is not paid within the period of 30 days within which payment is to be made, interest is payable on the amount remaining unpaid.
(2)The provisions of section 15A(3) to (5) of the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39) (rate of interest on unpaid duty, etc) apply in relation to interest under sub-paragraph (1).
6(1)The transferee company shall, within the period of 30 days mentioned in section 111(2)(b) within which payment is to be made, notify the Commissioners of—
(a)the date on which it ceased to be a member of the same group as the transferor company,
(b)the relevant land held by it at that time,
(c)the nature of the relevant instrument, the date on which it was executed, the parties to the instrument and the date on which the instrument was stamped,
(d)the market value of the land transferred to it by the relevant instrument at the date on which that instrument was executed, and
(e)the amount of duty and interest payable by it under section 111 or this Schedule.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1)(b) the “relevant land” held by the transferee company means every estate or interest to in relation to which section 111(1)(c) applies.
(3)In section 98(5) of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) (penalty for failure to provide information), in the second column of the Table, at the appropriate place insert “paragraph 6 of Schedule 34 to the Finance Act 2002".
7The provisions of regulations under section 98 of the Finance Act 1986 (c. 41) (stamp duty reserve tax: administration etc), and the provisions of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) applied by those regulations, have effect with the necessary modifications in relation to—
(a)the determination by the Commissioners of the duty payable under section 111 or the interest payable thereon,
(b)appeals against any such determination, and
(c)the collection and recovery of any such duty or interest,
as if it were an amount of stamp duty reserve tax.
8(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)an amount is payable under section 111 or this Schedule by the transferee company,
(b)a notice of determination of the amount payable has been issued by the Commissioners, and
(c)the whole or part of that amount is unpaid six months after the date on which it became payable.
(2)The following persons may, by notice under paragraph 9, be required to pay the unpaid amount—
(a)the transferor company;
(b)any company that, at any relevant time, was a member of the same group as the transferee company and was above it in the group structure;
(c)any person who at any relevant time was a controlling director of the transferee company or of a company having control of the transferee company.
(3)For the purposes of this paragraph—
(a)a “relevant time” means any time between the execution of the relevant instrument and the transferee company ceasing to be a member of the same group as the transferor company;
(b)a company is “above” another company in a group structure if it is the parent (within the meaning of the relevant group relief provision)—
(i)of that company, or
(ii)of another company that is above that company in the group structure.
(4)In this paragraph—
“director”, in relation to a company, has the meaning given by section 168(8) of the Taxes Act 1988 (read with subsection (9) of that section) and includes any person falling within section 417(5) of that Act (read with subsection (6) of that section); and
“controlling director”, in relation to a company, means a director of the company who has control of it (construing control in accordance with section 416 of the Taxes Act 1988).
9(1)The Commissioners may serve a notice on a person within paragraph 8(2) requiring him, within 30 days of the service of the notice, to pay the amount that remains unpaid.
(2)Any notice under this paragraph must be served before the end of the period of three years beginning with the date on which the notice of determination mentioned in paragraph 8(1)(b) is issued.
(3)The notice must state the amount required to be paid by the person on whom the notice is served.
(4)The notice has effect—
(a)for the purposes of the recovery from that person of the amount required to be paid and of interest on that amount, and
(b)for the purposes of appeals,
as if it were a notice of determination and that amount were an amount of stamp duty reserve tax due from that person.
(5)A person who has paid an amount in pursuance of a notice under this paragraph may recover that amount from the transferee company.
(6)A payment in pursuance of a notice under this paragraph is not allowed as a deduction in computing any income, profits or losses for any tax purposes.
10(1)The Commissioners may by notice require any person to furnish them within such time, not being less than 30 days, as may be specified in the notice with such information (including documents or records) as the Commissioners may reasonably require for the purposes of section 111 or this Schedule.
(2)A barrister or solicitor shall not be obliged in pursuance of a notice under this paragraph to disclose, without his client’s consent, any information with respect to which a claim to professional privilege could be maintained.
(3)In section 98(5) of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) (penalty for failure to comply with notice to provide information), in the first column of the Table, at the appropriate place insert “paragraph 10 of Schedule 34 to the Finance Act 2002".
11Section 111 and this Schedule shall be construed as one with the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39).
Section 113
1(1)The provisions of this Schedule supplement section 113 (withdrawal of relief under s.76 of the Finance Act 1986 (c. 41)).
(2)Expressions used in this Schedule that are defined for the purposes of that section have the same meaning in this Schedule.
2Section 113 does not apply by reason of control of the acquiring company changing as a result of any of the transactions listed in the Schedule to the Stamp Duty (Exempt Instruments) Regulations 1987 (S.I. 1987/516).
3(1)Section 113 does not apply by reason of control of the acquiring company changing as a result of a transfer of shares (“the intra-group transfer”) in relation to which group relief applies.
(2)In this paragraph—
(a)“group relief” means relief under section 42 of the Finance Act 1930 (c. 28) or section 11 of the Finance Act (Northern Ireland) 1954 (c. 23 (N.I.)) (transfer of property between associated bodies corporate); and
(b)references to a transfer in relation to which group relief applies are to a transfer such that an instrument effecting the transfer is exempt from stamp duty by virtue of either of the group relief provisions.
(3)But if before the end of the period of two years beginning with the date on which the relevant instrument was executed—
(a)a company (“company B”) holding shares in the acquiring company to which the intra-group share transfer related, or that are derived from shares to which that instrument related, ceases to be a member of the same group as the company referred to in section 76 as the target company (“company C”), and
(b)the acquiring company [F174or a relevant associated company], at that time, holds an estate or interest in land—
(i)that was transferred [F175to the acquiring company] by the relevant instrument, or
(ii)that is derived from an estate or interest so transferred,
[F176and that has not subsequently been transferred at market value by a duly stamped instrument on which ad valorem duty was paid and in respect of which section 76 relief was not claimed],
(4)In those circumstances—
(a)section 76 relief in relation to the relevant instrument (or an appropriate proportion of that relief) is withdrawn, and
(b)the additional stamp duty that would have been paid on stamping the relevant instrument but for that relief if the land in question had been transferred by that instrument at market value, or an appropriate proportion of that amount, is payable by the acquiring company within 30 days after company B ceases to be a member of the same group as company C.
(5)In this paragraph—
(a)“company” includes any body corporate; and
(b)references to a company being in the same group as another company are to the companies being associated bodies corporate within the meaning of the relevant group relief provision.
Textual Amendments
F174Words in Sch. 35 para. 3(3)(b) inserted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 127(6)(a)(9) (with s. 127(7)(8))
F175Words in Sch. 35 para. 3(3)(b)(i) substituted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 127(6)(b)(9) (with s. 127(7)(8))
F176Words in Sch. 35 para. 3(3)(b) substituted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 127(6)(c)(9) (with s. 127(7)(8))
4(1)Section 113 does not apply by reason of control of the acquiring company changing as a result of a transfer of shares (“the exempt transfer”) to another company (“the parent company”) in relation to which share acquisition relief applies.
(2)For this purpose—
(a)“ ” means relief under section 77 of the Finance Act 1986 (c. 41); and
(b)references to a transfer in relation to which such relief applies are to a transfer such that an instrument effecting the transfer is exempt from stamp duty by virtue of that provision.
(3)But if before the end of the period of two years beginning with the date on which the relevant instrument was executed—
(a)control of the parent company changes at a time when that company holds any shares transferred to it by the exempt transfer, or any shares derived from shares so transferred, and
(b)the acquiring company [F177or a relevant associated company], at that time, holds an estate or interest in land—
(i)that was transferred [F178to the acquiring company] by the relevant instrument, or
(ii)that is derived from an estate or interest so transferred,
[F179and that has not subsequently been transferred at market value by a duly stamped instrument on which ad valorem duty was paid and in respect of which section 76 relief was not claimed],
the following provisions apply.
(4)In those circumstances—
(a)section 76 relief in relation to the relevant instrument (or an appropriate proportion of that relief) is withdrawn, and
(b)the additional stamp duty that would have been paid on stamping the relevant instrument but for that relief if the land in question had been transferred by that instrument at market value, or an appropriate proportion of that additional duty, is payable by the acquiring company within 30 days after control of the parent company changed.
Textual Amendments
F177Words in Sch. 35 para. 4(3)(b) inserted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 127(6)(a)(9) (with s. 127(7)(8))
F178Words in Sch. 35 para. 4(3)(b)(i) substituted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 127(6)(b)(9) (with s. 127(7)(8))
F179Words in Sch. 35 para. 4(3)(b) substituted (retrospective to 15.4.2003) by Finance Act 2003 (c. 14), s. 127(6)(c)(9) (with s. 127(7)(8))
5(1)Section 113 does not apply by reason of control of the acquiring company changing as a result of a loan creditor becoming, or ceasing to be, treated as having control of the company if the other persons who were previously treated as controlling the company continue to be so treated.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1) “loan creditor” has the meaning given by section 417(7) to (9) of the Taxes Act 1988.
6(1)If any duty payable under section 113 or this Schedule is not paid within the period of 30 days within which payment is to be made, interest is payable on the amount remaining unpaid.
(2)The provisions of section 15A(3) to (5) of the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39) (rate of interest on unpaid duty, etc) apply in relation to interest under this paragraph.
7(1)The acquiring company shall, within the period of 30 days within which payment is to be made, notify the Commissioners of—
(a)the date on which the event occured by reason of which it is liable to make a payment of duty under section 113 or this Schedule,
(b)the relevant land held by it at that time,
(c)the nature of the relevant instrument, the date on which it was executed, the parties to the instrument and the date on which the instrument was stamped,
(d)the market value of the land transferred to it by the relevant instrument at the date it was executed, and
(e)the amount of duty and interest payable by it.
(2)In sub-paragraph (1)(b) the “relevant land” held by the acquiring company means every estate or interest to in relation to which section 113(1)(c) applies.
(3)In section 98(5) of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) (penalty for failure to provide information), in the second column of the Table, at the appropriate place insert “paragraph 7 of Schedule 35 to the Finance Act 2002".
8The provisions of regulations under section 98 of the Finance Act 1986 (c. 41) (stamp duty reserve tax: administration etc), and the provisions of the Taxes Management Act 1970 applied by those regulations, have effect with the necessary modifications in relation to—
(a)the determination by the Commissioners of the duty payable under section 113 or this Schedule, or of the interest payable thereon,
(b)appeals against any such determination, and
(c)the collection and recovery of any such duty or interest,
as if it were an amount of stamp duty reserve tax.
9(1)This paragraph applies where—
(a)an amount is payable under section 113 or this Schedule by the acquiring company,
(b)a notice of determination of the amount payable has been issued by the Inland Revenue, and
(c)the whole or part of that amount is unpaid six months after the date on which it became payable.
(2)The following persons may, by notice under paragraph 10, be required to pay the unpaid amount—
(a)any company that at any relevant time was a member of the same group as the acquiring company and was above it in the group structure, and
(b)any person who at any relevant time was a controlling director of the acquiring company or of a company having control of the acquiring company.
(3)For this purpose a “relevant time” means any time between the execution of the relevant instrument and the change of control by virtue of which the liability to pay the amount arises.
(4)In this paragraph—
(a)references to companies being in the same group are to one company having control of the other or both companies being under the control of the same person or persons;
(b)a company is “above” another company in a group structure if it controls—
(i)that company, or
(ii)another company that is above that company in the group structure;
(c)“director”, in relation to a company, has the meaning given by section 168(8) of the Taxes Act 1988 (read with subsection (9) of that section) and includes any person falling within section 417(5) of that Act (read with subsection (6) of that section); and
(d)“controlling director”, in relation to a company, means a director of the company who has control of it.
10(1)The Commissoners may serve a notice on a person within paragraph 9(2) requiring him, within 30 days of the service of the notice, to pay the amount that remains unpaid.
(2)A notice under this paragraph must be served before the end of the period of three years beginning with the date on which the notice of determination mentioned in paragraph 9(1)(b) is issued.
(3)The notice must state the amount required to be paid by the person on whom the notice is served.
(4)The notice has effect—
(a)for the purposes of the recovery from that person of the amount required to be paid and of interest on that amount, and
(b)for the purposes of appeals,
as if it were a notice of determination and that amount were an amount of stamp duty reserve tax due from that person.
(5)A person who has paid an amount in pursuance of a notice under this paragraph may recover that amount from the acquiring company.
(6)A payment in pursuance of a notice under this paragraph is not allowed as a deduction in computing any income, profits or losses for any tax purposes.
11(1)The Commissioners may by notice require any person to furnish them within such time, not being less than 30 days, as may be specified in the notice with such information (including documents or records) as the Commissioners may reasonably require for the purposes of section 113 or this Schedule.
(2)A barrister or solicitor shall not be obliged in pursuance of a notice under this paragraph to disclose, without his client’s consent, any information with respect to which a claim to professional privilege could be maintained.
(3)In section 98(5) of the Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) (penalty for failure to comply with notice to provide information), in the first column of the Table, at the appropriate place insert “paragraph 11 of Schedule 35 to the Finance Act 2002".
12Section 113 and this Schedule shall be construed as one with the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39).
Section 115(7)
1This Part of this Schedule has effect for affording relief from duty under section 115 (contracts chargeable as conveyances) on a subsale.
2For the purposes of this Schedule there is a subsale—
(a)where the purchaser under a contract or agreement for the sale of an estate or interest in land in the United Kingdom (“the original sale”), without having obtained a conveyance of the property contracted to be sold, contracts to sell the whole or part of the property to another person, or
(b)where the sub-purchaser under a subsale of an estate or interest in land in the United Kingdom, without having obtained a conveyance of the property contracted to be sold, contracts to sell to another person the whole or part of the property contracted to be sold by the original sale,
so as to entitle that person to call for a conveyance from the original seller.
3(1)Where duty under section 115 has been paid—
(a)on the original sale, or
(b)on an intervening subsale,
duty under that section on a subsale, or subsequent subsale, is chargeable only in respect of the amount (if any) by which the chargeable consideration on that transaction exceeds the chargeable consideration on the earlier transaction.
(2)If there is more than one such earlier transaction on which duty has been paid, the reference in sub-paragraph (1) to the chargeable consideration on the earlier transaction shall be read as a reference to the higher or highest amount of chargeable consideration on which duty has been paid.
(3)If the subsale does not relate to the whole of the property to which the earlier transaction related, the references in sub-paragraphs (1) and (2) to the chargeable consideration on an earlier transaction shall be read as references to an appropriate proportion of that consideration.
(4)What is an appropriate proportion shall be determined on a just and reasonable basis having regard to the subject matter of the subsale and of the earlier transaction.
(5)For the purposes of this paragraph the chargeable consideration on a transaction is the consideration that falls to be brought into account in determining the duty chargeable on it.
(6)Where under this paragraph duty on a subsale is chargeable in respect of part only of the consideration for the subsale, it is chargeable at the rate that would be applicable if the whole of the chargeable consideration on the subsale were taken into account.
4(1)This Part of this Schedule has effect for affording relief where ad valorem duty is chargeable both—
(a)under section 115 on a contract or agreement (“the original sale”), and
(b)on a subsequent conveyance or transfer by the original seller to the purchaser, or a sub-purchaser, in conformity with that contract or agreement.
(2)References in this Part to the purchaser under the original sale, or a sub-purchaser under a subsale, include a person by whom the rights of the purchaser, or a sub-purchaser, are exercisable by virtue of any assignment (in Scotland, assignation) or agreement (other than a subsale).
5(1)Where the original seller conveys the whole of the property contracted to be sold—
(a)to the purchaser, or
(b)to a sub-purchaser in circumstances in which section 58(4) of the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39) applies (conveyance chargeable only on consideration moving from sub-purchaser),
the conveyance or transfer is chargeable with duty only to the extent (if any) that the ad valorem duty chargeable on it (apart from this sub-paragraph) exceeds the duty paid under section 115 on the original sale together with the amount of any such duty paid on an intervening subsale.
(2)Where—
(a)the original seller conveys the property contracted to be sold to different sub-purchasers in parts or parcels, and
(b)section 58(5) of the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39) applies (conveyance chargeable only on consideration moving from sub-purchaser),
the conveyance or transfer of each part or parcel is chargeable with duty only to the extent (if any) that the ad valorem duty chargeable on it (apart from this sub-paragraph) exceeds an appropriate proportion of the ad valorem duty paid on the original sale together with an appropriate proportion of any such duty paid on an intervening subsale.
(3)What is an appropriate proportion shall be determined on a just and reasonable basis having regard to the subject matter of the conveyance or transfer and of the earlier transaction.
(4)Where sub-paragraph (1) or (2) applies to reduce or extinguish the duty payable on a conveyance or transfer, the Commissioners shall, upon application and upon production of the earlier instrument or instruments, duly stamped, either—
(a)denote the payment of the whole of the ad valorem duty upon the conveyance or transfer, or
(b)transfer to the conveyance or transfer the ad valorem duty paid on the earlier instrument or instruments.
6(1)Where—
(a)duty is paid under section 115 on the original sale,
(b)one or more conveyances or transfers are executed in conformity with that contract or agreement so that the whole of the property contracted to be sold is duly conveyed to a purchaser or to one or more sub-purchasers,
(c)those conveyances or transfers are all duly stamped, and
(d)the aggregate amount of the duty that would have been paid on those conveyances or transfers but for duty having been previously paid on the original sale is less than the duty paid on the original sale,
the Commissioners shall repay the difference to the person by whom the duty was paid on the original sale.
(2)If duty has been paid under section 115 on one or more intervening subsales, sub-paragraph (1) has effect with the following modifications—
(a)the reference to duty having been paid on the original sale shall be read as a reference to duty having been paid either on the original sale or on an intervening subsale;
(b)the reference to the amount of duty paid on the original sale shall be read as a reference to the aggregate of the amounts paid on the original sale and any intervening subsales, and
(c)any repayment shall be apportioned among the persons by whom those amounts were paid.
(3)The apportionment mentioned in sub-paragraph (2)(c) shall be made on a just and reasonable basis having regard to the subject matter of the original sale and of the subsale or subsales in question.
7Any reference in section 115 or this Schedule to duty chargeable or paid on a transaction is to duty chargeable or paid on the stamping of the instrument by which the transaction is effected.
8(1)Where a transaction relates both to land in the United Kingdom and to other property, section 115 and this Schedule apply as if there were separate transactions.
(2)Similarly, the reference in section 115(1)(b) to a series of transactions is to a series of transactions so far as relating to land in the United Kingdom.
(3)If, in a case where a transaction or series of transactions relates partly to land in the United Kingdom and partly to other property, the consideration is not apportioned in a manner that is just and reasonable, section 115 and this Schedule shall have effect as if the consideration had been apportioned in such a manner.
9It is for a person claiming any relief under this Schedule to prove to the satisfaction of the Commissioners that he is entitled to relief and in what amount.
10Section 115 and this Schedule shall be construed as one with the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39).
Section 116(2)
1(1)This paragraph applies where stamp duty under Part 1 of Schedule 13 to the Finance Act 1999 (c. 16) (conveyance or transfer on sale) is chargeable on an instrument that relates partly to goodwill and partly to property other than goodwill.
(2)In such a case—
(a)the consideration in respect of which duty would otherwise be charged shall be apportioned, on a just and reasonable basis, as between the goodwill and the other property, and
(b)the instrument shall be charged only in respect of the consideration attributed to the other property.
(3)This paragraph applies to instruments executed on or after 23rd April 2002.
2(1)Where part of the property referred to in section 58(1) of the Stamp Act 1891 (c. 39) (consideration to be apportioned between different instruments as parties think fit) consists of goodwill, that provision shall have effect as if “the parties think fit" read “is just and reasonable".
(2)Where—
(a)part of the property referred to in section 58(2) of the Stamp Act 1891 (property contracted to be purchased by two or more persons etc) consists of goodwill, and
(b)both or (as the case may be) all the relevant persons are connected with one another,
that provision shall have effect as if the words from “for distinct parts of the consideration" to the end of the subsection read “, the consideration shall be apportioned in such manner as is just and reasonable, so that a distinct consideration for each separate part or parcel is set forth in the conveyance relating thereto, and such conveyance is to be charged with ad valorem duty in respect of such distinct consideration.".
(3)In a case where sub-paragraph (1) or (2) applies and the consideration is apportioned in a manner that is not just and reasonable, the enactments relating to stamp duty shall have effect as if—
(a)the consideration had been apportioned in a manner that is just and reasonable, and
(b)the amount of any distinct consideration set forth in any conveyance relating to a separate part or parcel of property were such amount as is found by a just and reasonable apportionment (and not the amount actually set forth).
(4)For the purposes of sub-paragraph (2)—
(a)a person is a relevant person if he is a person by or for whom the property is contracted to be purchased;
(b)the question whether persons are connected with one another shall be determined in accordance with section 839 of the Taxes Act 1988.
(5)This paragraph applies to instruments executed on or after 23rd April 2002.
3(1)Goodwill shall be disregarded for the purposes of paragraph 6 of Schedule 13 to the Finance Act 1999 (c. 19) (certification of instrument as not forming part of transaction or series of transactions exceeding specified amount).
(2)Any statement as mentioned in paragraph 6(1) of that Schedule shall be construed as leaving out of account any matter which is to be so disregarded.
(3)This paragraph applies to instruments executed on or after 23rd April 2002.
4(1)Section 12 of the Finance Act 1895 (c. 16) (property vested by Act or purchased under statutory powers) does not require any person who is authorised to purchase any property as mentioned in that section after 23rd April 2002 to include any goodwill in the instrument of conveyance required by that section to be produced to the Commissioners.
(2)If the property consists wholly of goodwill no instrument of conveyance need be produced to the Commissioners under that section.
(3)This paragraph applies where the Act mentioned in that section, and by virtue of which property is vested or a person is authorised to purchase property, is passed after 23rd April 2002.
5In this Schedule “the enactments relating to stamp duty” means the Stamp Act 1891 (c.39) and any enactment amending that Act or that is to be construed as one with that Act.
Section 132
1This Schedule makes amendments to provisions of Part 2 of the Finance Act 2001 (c. 9) (aggregates levy).
2In section 16(1) (charge to aggregates levy), for “A levy" substitute “ A tax ”.
3(1)Section 17 (meaning of “aggregate" etc) is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (2) (meaning of “taxable" aggregate), for paragraph (d) substitute—
“(d)it is aggregate that on the commencement date is on a site other than—
(i)its originating site, or
(ii)a site that is required to be registered under the name of a person who is the operator, or one of the operators, of that originating site.”.
(3)In subsection (3)(d) (exemption for aggregate won in the course of road works), in sub-paragraph (ii) for “otherwise than wholly or mainly" substitute “ not ”.
(4)In subsection (4), in paragraph (d) (exemption for cuttings from oil drilling)—
(a)after “the Petroleum Act 1998" insert “ or the Petroleum (Production) Act (Northern Ireland) 1964 ”;
(b)omit the words from “otherwise" to the end (which restrict the exemption to off-shore drilling).
4(1)Section 18 (exempt processes) is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (2)(c) (exemption for production of lime etc), for “some other substance" substitute “ anything else ”.
(3)In subsection (3) (meaning of “relevant substance"), omit paragraphs (d) (calcite) and (h) (flint).
5(1)Section 19 (commercial exploitation) is amended as follows.
(2)In subsection (2) (description of sites removal of aggregate from which counts as exploitation), in paragraph (b) for the words from “who is the operator" to the end substitute “ under whose name that originating site is also registered ”.
(3)After subsection (3) (meaning of “commercial" exploitation) insert—
“(3A)For the purposes of subsection (3)(a) above “business” includes any activity of a Government department, local authority or charity.”.
(4)In subsection (4) (exemption in certain cases where aggregate is won from one site and incorporated into a neighbouring site), for the words “adjacent land" in both places substitute “ other land ”.
6In section 22 (which determines who is taken to be responsible for exploitation of aggregate), at the end of subsection (2) (responsibility for “commercial" exploitation) insert—
“For the purposes of this subsection “business” includes any activity of a Government department, local authority or charity.”.
7In section 24 (the register), in subsection (6) (premises that may be registered) insert after paragraph (c)—
“(ca)for mixing, otherwise than in permitted circumstances (within the meaning given by section 19(7)), any aggregate with any material or substance other than water,”.
8In section 37 (regulations about cases of insolvency etc), in subsection (7) (meaning of “insolvency procedure) omit paragraphs (g) to (j) (appointment of receiver and other interim or provisional orders).
9(1)Paragraph 1 of Schedule 4 (notification of registrability etc) is amended as follows.
(2)For sub-paragraph (1) substitute—
“(1)An unregistered person who—
(a)is required to be registered for the purposes of aggregates levy, or
(b)has formed the intention of carrying out taxable activities that are registrable,
shall notify the Commissioners of that fact.
(1A)An unregistered person who—
(a)would be required to be registered for the purposes of aggregates levy but for an exemption by virtue of regulations under section 24(4) of this Act, or
(b)has formed the intention of carrying out taxable activities that would be registrable but for such an exemption,
shall, in such cases or circumstances as may be prescribed in the regulations, notify the Commissioners of that fact.
(1B)For the purposes of sub-paragraphs (1) and (1A) above, taxable activities are “registrable” if a person carrying them out is, by reason of doing so, required by section 24(2) of this Act to be registered for the purposes of aggregates levy.”.
(3)In sub-paragraphs (2) and (5), after “sub-paragraph (1)" insert “ or (1A) ”.
10In paragraph 11 of Schedule 8 (restriction on powers to provide for set-off), in sub-paragraph (2) (meaning of “insolvency procedure") omit paragraphs (f), (g) and (h) (appointment of receiver and other interim or provisional orders).
Section 134(1)
Modifications etc. (not altering text)
C5Sch. 39 applied (with modifications) (22.7.2004) by Finance Act 2004 (c. 12), s. 322
1(1)This Schedule applies where in accordance with the Mutual Assistance Recovery Directive an authority in another member State makes a request for the recovery in the United Kingdom of a sum claimed by that authority in that State.
(2)In this Schedule—
(a)the “Mutual Assistance Recovery Directive” has the meaning given by section 134; and
(b)the “foreign claim” means the claim in relation to which a request under that Directive is made as mentioned in sub-paragraph (1).
2(1)Subject to the following provisions of this Schedule—
(a)such proceedings may be taken by or on behalf of the relevant UK authority to enforce the foreign claim, by way of legal proceedings, distress, diligence or otherwise, as might be taken to enforce a corresponding UK claim, and
(b)any enactment or rule of law relating to a corresponding UK claim shall apply, with any necessary adaptations, in relation to the foreign claim.
(2)“The relevant UK authority” means—
(a)in relation to matters corresponding to those within the care and management of the Commissioners of Customs and Excise, those Commissioners;
(b)in relation to matters corresponding to those within the care and management of the Commissioners of Inland Revenue, those Commissioners;
(c)in relation to agricultural levies of the European Community, the relevant Minister, that is—
(i)in England, the Secretary of State,
(ii)in Scotland, the Scottish Ministers,
(iii)in Wales, the National Assembly for Wales, and
(iv)in Northern Ireland, the Department of Agriculture and Rural Development.
(3)A “corresponding UK claim” means a claim in the United Kingdom corresponding to the foreign claim.
(4)The enactments referred to in sub-paragraph (1)(b) include, in particular, those relating to the recovery of penalties and of interest on unpaid amounts.
3(1)The Treasury may make provision by regulations—
(a)as to what is a corresponding UK claim in relation to any description of foreign claim, and
(b)as to such other procedural and other supplementary matters as appear to them appropriate for implementing the Mutual Assistance Recovery Directive.
(2)In relation to a case where there is no claim in the United Kingdom that is directly equivalent to a particular description of foreign claim, regulations under sub-paragraph (1)(a) may prescribe as the corresponding UK claim one that appears to the Treasury to be closest to an equivalent.
(3)The power conferred by sub-paragraph (1)(b) includes power to make any provision appearing to the Treasury to be appropriate to give effect to any Commission Directive laying down detailed rules for implementing the Mutual Assistance Recovery Directive.
(4)The relevant UK authority may make provision by regulations as to the application, non-application or adaptation in relation to foreign claims of any enactment or rule of law applicable to corresponding UK claims.
This is without prejudice to the application of any such enactment or rule in relation to foreign claims in circumstances not dealt with by regulations under this sub-paragraph.
(5)Regulations under this paragraph shall be made by statutory instrument which shall be subject to annulment in pursuance of a resolution of the House of Commons.
4(1)Except where permitted by virtue of regulations under paragraph 3(4) applying an enactment that permits such proceedings in the case of a corresponding UK claim, no proceedings under this Schedule shall be taken against a person if he shows that proceedings relevant to his liability on the foreign claim are pending, or are about to be instituted, before a court, tribunal or other competent body in the member State in question.
(2)For this purpose proceedings are pending so long as an appeal may be brought against any decision in the proceedings.
(3)Proceedings under this Schedule may be taken if the proceedings in the member State are not prosecuted or instituted with reasonable expedition.
5(1)No proceedings under this Schedule shall be taken against a person if a final decision on the foreign claim has been given in his favour by a court, tribunal or other competent body in the member State in question.
(2)For this purpose a final decision is one against which no appeal lies or against which an appeal lies within a period that has expired without an appeal having been brought.
(3)If he shows that such a decision has been given in respect of part of the claim no proceedings under this Schedule shall be taken in relation to that part.
6For the purposes of proceedings under this Schedule—
(a)a request made by an authority in another member State shall be taken to be duly made in accordance with the Mutual Assistance Recovery Directive unless the contrary is proved, and
(b)except as mentioned in paragraph 5, no question may be raised as to a person’s liability on the foreign claim.
Section 141
This repeal shall be deemed to have come into force on 28th April 2002. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Alcoholic Liquor Duties Act 1979 (c. 4) | Section 1(9). |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 (c. 5) | In section 6AB(1), the words from “and delivered" to the end. |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | Section 9(2) and (3). |
1 The repeal in the Hydrocarbon Oil Duties Act 1979 has effect in accordance with section 5(8)(c) of this Act.
2 The repeals in the Finance Act 1988 have effect in accordance with section 5(8)(b) of this Act.
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 8(6) of this Act., | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 (c. 63) | In section 26(2), the definition of “thirty-five-penny machine". |
Finance Act 1995 (c. 4) | In Schedule 3, paragraph 8(2)(b). |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Excise Duties (Surcharges or Rebates) Act 1979 (c. 8) | In section 1(3), the words from “, except that if the duty is pool betting duty" to the end. |
Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 (c. 63) | In section 2(2), paragraph (d) and the word “or" preceding it. In section 9(2), the words “or coupon betting" (in both places). In section 9(3)(a), the words “or coupon betting". In section 9(3)(aa)(i), the words “or coupon betting". Section 9(4). Section 11. In section 12(3), the words “(except in sections 6, 7, 8, 9(2)(a) and 9(5) in their application to coupon betting)". In Schedule 1— (a) in paragraph 3, the words “shall be under the care and management of the Commissioners, and"; (b) paragraphs 4(4) to (6), 6(2)(b), 8 and 12; (c) in paragraph 14(1), the words after paragraph (b). |
Finance Act 1986 (c. 41) | In Schedule 4, paragraph 2(1). |
Finance Act 1993 (c. 34) | Section 39(a). |
Finance Act 2001 (c. 9) | In Schedule 1, the second paragraph (which begins “In section 6(1)"). |
1 The repeal of section 9(4) of the Betting and Gaming Duties Act 1981 has effect in accordance with section 14(6) of this Act.
2 The other repeals have effect in accordance with section 12 of this Act.
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 (c. 22) | Section 57(8). In Schedule 1, paragraph 2(4). |
Finance Act 1995 (c. 4) | In Schedule 4, paragraph 7. |
1 The repeal of paragraph 2(4) of Schedule 1 to the Vehicle Excise and Registration Act 1994 has effect subject to the saving in section 20(3) of this Act.
2 The repeal of paragraph 7 of Schedule 4 to the Finance Act 1995 has effect in accordance with section 18(3) of this Act.
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Customs and Excise Manage-ment Act 1979 (c. 2) | Section 133(3). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 22(3) of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Value Added Tax Act 1994 (c. 23) | Section 36(4A) and (5)(ea). |
Finance Act 1997 (c. 16) | Section 39(2) to (4). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 24(5) and (6) of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Value Added Tax Act 1994 (c. 23) | Section 6(9). In paragraph 2 of Schedule 11— (a) in the heading, the words “, VAT invoices"; (b) in sub-paragraph (1), the words from “and may require" to the end; (c) sub-paragraphs (2) and (2A). |
Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) | Section 38(2). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 40(4) of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | In section 559— (a) in subsection (4), the words from “and the sum so deducted" to the end; (b) subsections (5) and (5A); (c) subsection (8). |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | In Schedule 7, in paragraph 1 the words “559(4)(b) and (5) (twice)". In Schedule 8, paragraph 2(1). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with paragraphs 7 and 8 of Schedule 9 to this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | In section 842(3)(c), the words “or amalgamation". |
Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) | In the heading before section 135, the words “and amalgamations". In section 139(1), in the heading, in subsection (1)(a) and in subsection (5) (twice), the words “or amalgamation". In section 211(2)— (a) in paragraph (a), and (b) in the closing words, the words “or amalgamation". In section 214C(2)(a) and (3), the words “or amalgamation". |
Finance (No. 2) Act 1992 (c. 48) | Section 35(1). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with paragraphs 2, 4 and 7 of Schedule 10 to this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) | In section 2A(8)(b)(ii), the words “11 or". In Schedule A1— (a) paragraph 11; (b) in paragraph 22(1), in the definition of “51 per cent subsidiary", the words “(except in paragraph 11 above)"; (c) in paragraph 23, the final sentence of sub-paragraph (4), sub-paragraph (5), in sub-paragraph (7) the words “, (5)(b)" and sub-paragraphs (9) and (10); (d) paragraph 24(6). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with paragraphs 7 and 8 of Schedule 11 to this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) | In section 2(5)(b), the words “77, 86,". Section 77(6A). Section 86(4A). In section 86A(8), the words “or aggregate amount". |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | In Schedule 21, paragraph 6(1) and (2). |
These repeals have effect for accounting periods ending on or after 1st April 2002. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) | In Schedule 20— (a) in paragraph 5(1)(c), the words “(within the meaning of section 231A(4) of the Taxes Act 1988)"; (b) in paragraph 12, the word “and" at the end of paragraph (a). |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 57(3) and (4)(b) of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance Act 1990 (c. 29) | In section 25(7), the word “and" at the end of paragraph (b). |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Capital Allowances Act 2001 (c. 2) | In section 39, the word “or" preceding the words “section 45A". In section 46(1), the word “or" preceding the words “section 45A". In section 74(2), the word “and" preceding paragraph (b). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 59 of this Act.
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | In section 473(2), the words, “, if the securities were not such as are mentioned in subsection (1)(b) above". |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | Section 44. Schedule 6. |
Capital Allowances Act 2001 | In Schedule 2, paragraph 102. |
The repeal in section 473(2) of the Taxes Act 1988 has effect in accordance with section 67(4)(a) of this Act.
The other repeals have effect in accordance with section 64(6) of and paragraphs 16 and 17 of Schedule 22 to this Act.
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) | In section 92, in subsection (1)(e), the word “and". Section 93(11) and (13). |
The repeal in section 92 of the Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) has effect in accordance with section 72 of this Act.
The repeals in section 93 of that Act have effect in accordance with section 75 of this Act.
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | In section 15(1), the second indent of paragraph 2(3) of Schedule A. Section 56(3A) to (3D). In Schedule 24, paragraphs 13 to 19. In Schedule 27, paragraph 5(2A) so far as relating to sections 125 to 133 of the Finance Act 1993. |
Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) | In section 117(A1), the words “(subject to sections 117A and 117B below)". Sections 117A and 117B. |
Finance Act 1993 (c. 34) | Section 60. Sections 125 to 169. Schedules 15 to 17. In Schedule 18, paragraph 2. |
Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) | Sections 114 to 116. Section 226(2). |
Finance Act 1995 (c. 4) | Section 52(2). Section 131. In Schedule 24, paragraphs 1 to 3. In Schedule 25, paragraphs 6(5) and 7. |
Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) | In section 85(2), the word “and" at the end of paragraph (b). In section 92(6)(b), the words “127 or". In Schedule 9— (a) paragraphs 4 and 11(4); (b) in paragraph 13(6), the definition of “related transaction"; (c) in paragraph 15(1), the words “for the purposes of section 84 of this Act". In Schedule 11, in paragraph 3A(1)(b), the words “debt or". In Schedule 14, paragraphs 67 to 74. In Schedule 15, paragraphs 22 to 24. In Schedule 20, paragraphs 68 to 70. |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | Section 108(3) and (4)(a). In section 109— (a) subsections (1) and (2); (b) subsection (4) so far as relating to those subsections; (c) subsection (5) so far as relating to the enactments specified in paragraph (a) of it. Section 110(4)(b). Schedule 4, paragraph 7. |
Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) | Section 106. In Schedule 22, paragraph 50(2)(b). In Schedule 29, paragraphs 20, 21 and 41 to 43. |
The repeal in Schedule 27 to the Taxes Act 1988 has effect for account periods beginning on or after 1st October 2002.
The other repeals have effect in accordance with section 79(3) of this Act and Schedule 23 to this Act.
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 80 of this Act and Schedule 24 to this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance Act 1993 (c. 34) | In section 93, subsections (3) and (6) and, in subsection (7), the definitions of “branch" and “the closing rate/net investment method". |
Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) | Section 226(1). |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | Section 163(3)(b) and (c). |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 82(2) of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | In section 77(2)(a), sub-paragraph (ii) and the preceding word “or". Section 403ZC(2). In section 432A(9B), the definition of “money debt". In section 797A, the second sentence in subsection (5) and in subsection (7). In Schedule 28A— (a) in paragraph 7, in sub-paragraph (1)(d), the word “and" preceding sub-paragraph (iii), in sub-paragraph (1)(e), the word “and" preceding sub-paragraph (iii), and sub-paragraph (2); (b) in paragraph 16, in sub-paragraph (1)(d), the word “and" preceding sub-paragraph (iii), in sub-paragraph (1)(e), the word “and" preceding sub-paragraph (iii), and sub-paragraph (2). |
Finance Act 1988 (c. 39) | In Schedule 6, in paragraph 3— (a) sub-paragraphs (3)(a), (4)(a) and (5)(a) and (b); (b) in sub-paragraph (5), in the words following paragraph (c), the word “group"; (c) sub-paragraph (6). |
Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) | In section 83— (a) in subsection (2), paragraphs (b) and (d) and the word “or" at the end of paragraph (c); (b) subsection (4); (c) in subsection (7), in paragraph (a), the word “(b)", and paragraph (b) and the preceding word “and". In section 87— (a) in subsection (3), in paragraph (a) the words “or in the two years before the beginning of that period", in paragraph (b) the words “or in those two years", and paragraph (c) and the preceding word “or"; (b) subsections (6) to (8). Section 89. Section 91. In Schedule 8, paragraph 2. In Schedule 9, in paragraph 17— (a) in sub-paragraph (5), in paragraph (a) the words “or in the period of two years before the beginning of that period" and in paragraph (b) the words “or in those two years"; (b) sub-paragraphs (6) and (7). In Schedule 9, in paragraph 18— (a) in sub-paragraph (1), the word “and" immediately preceding paragraph (b); (b) in sub-paragraph (4), the definition of “control". |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | Section 82(1) and (2)(c) and (e). |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | Section 468AA. In section 807A(7), the definition of “relevant qualifying payment". In Schedule 5AA— (a) in paragraph 1, sub-paragraphs (2)(b) and (c) and (3), in sub-paragraph (5), the words “and 396", in sub-paragraph (6), the words “, corporation tax" and “or 396", and sub-paragraph (7); (b) paragraph 2(3); (c) paragraph 4(4A); (d) in paragraph 4A, in sub-paragraph (5)(b), the words “or 396", and sub-paragraph (10A); (e) paragraph 6(3A); (f) paragraph 9. In Schedule 27, paragraph 5(2A) so far as relating to sections 159 and 160 of, and paragraph 1 of Schedule 18 to, the Finance Act 1994. |
Finance Act 1990 (c. 29) | Section 81(1). |
Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) | Sections 147 to 175. Section 177. Schedule 18. |
Finance Act 1995 (c. 4) | Section 52(3). Section 132. |
Finance Act 1996 (c. 8) | Section 93A(3)(a) and (7). Section 101(2) to (6). Schedule 12. In Schedule 14, paragraphs 75 to 79. In Schedule 15, paragraph 25. In Schedule 20, paragraph 71. |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | Section 99(2) and (3). In section 109— (a) subsection (3); (b) subsection (4) so far as relating to subsection (3); (c) subsection (5) so far as relating to the enactments specified in paragraph (b) of it. |
Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) | In Schedule 30, paragraph 24(3). |
Finance Act 2002 (c. 23) | Sections 69 and 70. Section 78. |
The repeal in Schedule 27 to the Taxes Act 1988 has effect for account periods beginning on or after 1st October 2002.
The other repeals have effect in accordance with section 83(3) of this Act.
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 94(7) of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | Section 349B(1)(b) and the word “or" preceding it. |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 97 of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 | In section 587B(9), the word “and" preceding paragraph (d). |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Taxes Management Act 1970 (c. 9) | In section 12AB(5), the definition of “period of account". |
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | Section 43A(2). Section 91A(8). Section 91B(11)(e) and the word “and" preceding it. In section 297(5B), the second sentence. Section 494AA(2)(b) and the word “or" preceding it. In section 560(2), the words from “and in paragraph (f)" to the end. In section 834(1), in the definition of “accounting date", the words from “and “period of account"" to the end. Section 837A(5). In section 842B(2), the second sentence. In Schedule 5, in paragraphs 2(6) and 6(4), the definitions of “period of account". In Schedule 28B, in paragraph 4(6B), the second sentence. |
Finance Act 1988 (c. 39) | In section 86(3), the definition of “period of account". |
Finance Act 1989 (c. 26) | In section 43(9), the definition of “period of account". |
Taxation of Chargeable Gains Act 1992 (c. 12) | In section 161(3A), the words from “and in paragraph (a)" to the end. In section 13(5B), the second sentence. |
Finance Act 1997 (c. 16) | In Schedule 12— (a) in paragraph 1(1)(c), the words “, in the case of companies incorporated in any part of the United Kingdom," and “for the purposes of the accounts of such companies"; (b) in paragraph 4(5), the words “, if the recipient were a company incorporated in the United Kingdom,"; (c) in paragraph 15(1)(c), the words “, in the case of companies incorporated in any part of the United Kingdom," and “for the purposes of the accounts of such companies"; (d) paragraph 28(1) to (4). |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | Section 45. In Schedule 18, in paragraph 14(2), the second sentence. |
Finance Act 1999 (c. 16) | In Schedule 6, paragraph 3(5). |
Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) | In Schedule 14, in paragraph 22(4), the second sentence. In Schedule 15, in paragraph 29(4), the second sentence. In Schedule 20, in paragraph 25(1), the definition of “normal accounting practice". In Schedule 23, in paragraph 5, the definitions of “normal accounting practice" and “statutory accounts". |
Capital Allowances Act 2001 (c. 2) | Section 179(2). Section 219(2). |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988 (c. 1) | Section 100(1B)(a). |
Finance Act 1988 (c. 39) | In Schedule 12, paragraph 2. |
These repeals have effect in accordance with section 107 of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance (No. 2) Act 1992 (c. 48) | In Schedule 12, paragraphs 3(3)(c) and 4(3). |
Finance Act 1998 (c. 36) | In Schedule 7, in paragraph 8, the words “3(3)(c) and". |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 121 of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance Act 1994 (c. 9) | In section 30(2), the word “or" preceding paragraph (b). |
This repeal has effect in accordance with section 125(2) of this Act. | |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance Act 2000 (c. 17) | In Schedule 6, in paragraph 20(7), paragraph (c) and the preceding word “and". |
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance Act 2001 (c. 9) | In section 17— (a) subsection (3)(a); (b) in subsection (4), paragraph (b) and the words in paragraph (d) from “otherwise" to the end. Section 18(3)(d) and (h). In section 20(1)— (a) the words “and is not rock" in paragraphs (a) and (b); (b) paragraph (c). Section 21(2)(b). Section 24(6)(b) and (8)(a). Section 37(7)(g) to (j). In Schedule 6, in paragraph 7(1), paragraph (b) and the words from “equal to the amount" to the end. In Schedule 8, in paragraph 11(2), paragraphs (f), (g) and (h). |
The repeals in Schedule 6 to the Finance Act 2001 shall be deemed to have come into force on 1st May 2002.
The other repeals shall be deemed to have come into force on 1st April 2002.
Short title and chapter | Extent of repeal |
---|---|
Finance Act 1977 (c. 36) | Section 11. |
Finance Act 1980 (c. 48) | In section 17— (a) subsection (1); (b) in subsection (2A), the words “(1) and"; (c) in subsection (3), the words from the beginning to “passing of this Act;". |
The Whole Act you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.
Would you like to continue?
The Schedules you have selected contains over 200 provisions and might take some time to download. You may also experience some issues with your browser, such as an alert box that a script is taking a long time to run.
Would you like to continue?
Latest Available (revised):The latest available updated version of the legislation incorporating changes made by subsequent legislation and applied by our editorial team. Changes we have not yet applied to the text, can be found in the ‘Changes to Legislation’ area.
Original (As Enacted or Made): The original version of the legislation as it stood when it was enacted or made. No changes have been applied to the text.
Point in Time: This becomes available after navigating to view revised legislation as it stood at a certain point in time via Advanced Features > Show Timeline of Changes or via a point in time advanced search.
Geographical Extent: Indicates the geographical area that this provision applies to. For further information see ‘Frequently Asked Questions’.
Show Timeline of Changes: See how this legislation has or could change over time. Turning this feature on will show extra navigation options to go to these specific points in time. Return to the latest available version by using the controls above in the What Version box.
Access essential accompanying documents and information for this legislation item from this tab. Dependent on the legislation item being viewed this may include:
This timeline shows the different points in time where a change occurred. The dates will coincide with the earliest date on which the change (e.g an insertion, a repeal or a substitution) that was applied came into force. The first date in the timeline will usually be the earliest date when the provision came into force. In some cases the first date is 01/02/1991 (or for Northern Ireland legislation 01/01/2006). This date is our basedate. No versions before this date are available. For further information see the Editorial Practice Guide and Glossary under Help.
Use this menu to access essential accompanying documents and information for this legislation item. Dependent on the legislation item being viewed this may include:
Click 'View More' or select 'More Resources' tab for additional information including: